Samsung SCX 8123 8128 SM

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 404
At a glance
Powered by AI
The document appears to be a service manual that describes the various components, functions, and specifications of a copier/scanner system. It also outlines important safety precautions that should be followed when servicing the device.

The feeding system overview describes the main components like the cassettes/trays, pickup rollers, and separation pads. It explains their functions in feeding paper through the system.

Safety precautions discussed include warnings about electric shock, handling toxic materials, and ensuring proper grounding to prevent electrostatic discharge when servicing parts.

A3 Mono Copier

SCX-8123/8128 series
SCX-8123ND/NA,
SCX-8128ND/NA

SERVICE MANUAL
A3 Mono Copier Contents

1. Precautions

2. Product Specifications and Description

3. Disassembly and Reassembly

4. Troubleshooting

5. System Diagram

6. Reference Information

Refer to the service manual in the GSPN (see the rear cover) for more information.
Contents

Contents
1. Precautions ........................................................................................................................................1 1
1.1. Safety warning ..........................................................................................................................1 1
1.2. Caution for safety ......................................................................................................................1 2
1.2.1. Toxic material...............................................................................................................1 2
1.2.2. Electric shock and fire safety precautions ...........................................................................1 2
1.2.3. Handling precautions .....................................................................................................1 3
1.2.4. Assembly and Disassembly precautions .............................................................................1 3
1.2.5. Disregarding this warning may cause bodily injury ..............................................................1 4
1.3. ESD precautions ........................................................................................................................1 5
2. Product Specifications and Description ....................................................................................................2 1
2.1. Product Overview ......................................................................................................................2 1
2.2. Specifications............................................................................................................................2 2
2.2.1. General Specification .....................................................................................................2 2
2.2.2. Print Specifications ........................................................................................................2 4
2.2.3. Controller and Software specification ................................................................................2 5
2.2.4. Scan specification ..........................................................................................................2 8
2.2.5. Copy specification ....................................................................................................... 2 10
2.2.6. Fax specification ......................................................................................................... 2 12
2.2.7. Paper Handling specification.......................................................................................... 2 15
2.2.8. Consumables .............................................................................................................. 2 18
2.2.9. Maintenance Parts ....................................................................................................... 2 18
2.2.10. Option....................................................................................................................... 2 19
2.3. Feeding System ....................................................................................................................... 2 21
2.3.1. Feeding System Overview............................................................................................. 2 21
2.3.2. Main Components and functions .................................................................................... 2 22
2.3.3. Cassette (Tray 1,2,3,4).................................................................................................. 2 26
2.3.4. Pick-Up Unit .............................................................................................................. 2 27
2.3.5. Registration Unit ......................................................................................................... 2 28
2.3.6. MPF(Multi-Purpose Feeder) Unit ................................................................................... 2 29
2.4. Image Creation........................................................................................................................ 2 30
2.4.1. Printing process overview ............................................................................................. 2 30
2.4.2. Imaging Unit .............................................................................................................. 2 31
2.4.2.1. Imaging Unit overview................................................................................... 2 31
2.4.2.2. Drum Drive.................................................................................................. 2 32
2.4.2.3. Developer Unit ............................................................................................. 2 33
2.5. Fuser unit ............................................................................................................................... 2 35
2.5.1. Fuser Unit overview..................................................................................................... 2 35
2.5.2. Fuser unit drive ........................................................................................................... 2 36

i Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


Contents

2.5.3. Fuser unit temperature control........................................................................................ 2 37


2.6. Laser Scanning Unit (LSU)........................................................................................................ 2 38
2.6.1. LSU overview............................................................................................................. 2 38
2.6.2. Laser Scanning Optical path .......................................................................................... 2 39
2.6.3. Laser synchronizing detectors ........................................................................................ 2 40
2.7. Drive System .......................................................................................................................... 2 41
2.7.1. Drive Motors .............................................................................................................. 2 41
2.7.2. Main Drive Unit (OPC_DEVE_Regi_MP_Feed) ............................................................... 2 42
2.7.3. Pick Up Drive............................................................................................................. 2 45
2.7.4. Duct Drive ................................................................................................................. 2 46
2.7.5. Fuser/ Exit Drive ......................................................................................................... 2 47
2.7.6. Toner Supply Drive...................................................................................................... 2 48
2.8. Scanner System ....................................................................................................................... 2 49
2.8.1. Scanner System Overview............................................................................................. 2 49
2.8.2. Scanning System Components ....................................................................................... 2 49
2.9. Duplex Automatic Document Feeder(DADF)................................................................................ 2 52
2.9.1. DADF overview.......................................................................................................... 2 52
2.9.2. Electrical parts location ................................................................................................ 2 53
2.9.3. DADF Drive System .................................................................................................... 2 54
2.9.3.1. DADF Original Drive Assembly ...................................................................... 2 55
2.9.3.2. DADF Original Registration (Regi) Drive Assembly............................................ 2 56
2.9.3.3. DADF Feed Drive Assembly ........................................................................... 2 56
2.9.3.4. DADF Exit Drive Assembly............................................................................ 2 57
2.9.3.5. Original Return Drive .................................................................................... 2 57
2.10. Hardware Configuration ............................................................................................................ 2 58
2.10.1. Main Controller .......................................................................................................... 2 60
2.10.2. OPE controller ............................................................................................................ 2 64
2.10.3. ADF PBA .................................................................................................................. 2 67
2.10.4. SMPS board ............................................................................................................... 2 68
2.10.5. Fuser Drive Board (FDB).............................................................................................. 2 70
2.10.6. HVPS board ............................................................................................................... 2 71
2.10.7. Eraser PBA ................................................................................................................ 2 72
2.10.8. Fuser PBA ................................................................................................................. 2 72
2.10.9. Waste Sensor PBA....................................................................................................... 2 73
2.10.10. CRUM PBA ............................................................................................................... 2 73
2.10.11. Deve CRUM Joint PBA ............................................................................................... 2 73
2.10.12. Toner CRUM Joint PBA .............................................................................................. 2 74
2.10.13. Scan Joint PBA ........................................................................................................... 2 74
2.10.14. CCDM PBA ............................................................................................................... 2 75
2.10.15. WLED CTL PBA ........................................................................................................ 2 75

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. ii


Contents

2.10.16. WLED AL FRONT PBA .............................................................................................. 2 76


2.11. DCF Unit ............................................................................................................................... 2 77
2.12. Finisher ................................................................................................................................. 2 83
3. Disassembly and Reassembly ................................................................................................................3 1
3.1. Precautions when replacing parts ..................................................................................................3 1
3.1.1. Precautions when assembling and disassembling .................................................................3 1
3.1.2. Precautions when handling PBA.......................................................................................3 1
3.1.3. Releasing Plastic Latches ................................................................................................3 2
3.2. Replacing the maintenance part ....................................................................................................3 3
3.2.1. Developer_Drum Unit_Developer Unit..............................................................................3 3
3.2.2. Fuser Unit ....................................................................................................................3 6
3.2.3. Transfer roller...............................................................................................................3 6
3.2.4. Ozone Filter .................................................................................................................3 7
3.2.5. Pick Up_Reverse_Forward Roller.....................................................................................3 7
3.2.6. MP Pick Up_Reverse_Forward ........................................................................................3 8
3.2.7. DADF Pick-up roller Assy ..............................................................................................3 9
3.2.8. DADF friction pad.........................................................................................................3 9
3.3. Replacing the main SVC part ..................................................................................................... 3 10
3.3.1. Left cover .................................................................................................................. 3 10
3.3.2. Rear Cover................................................................................................................. 3 10
3.3.3. LSU.......................................................................................................................... 3 11
3.3.4. Temperature Sensor ..................................................................................................... 3 11
3.3.5. HVPS board ............................................................................................................... 3 12
3.3.6. OPC Blow-In Fan........................................................................................................ 3 13
3.3.7. OPE Unit ................................................................................................................... 3 14
3.3.8. Main board................................................................................................................. 3 17
3.3.9. Ozone Suction Fan ...................................................................................................... 3 17
3.3.10. SMPS board ............................................................................................................... 3 18
3.3.11. FDB board ................................................................................................................. 3 19
3.3.12. Fuser_Exit Drive Unit .................................................................................................. 3 19
3.3.13. Main Drive Unit.......................................................................................................... 3 20
3.3.14. Pick-up Drive unit ....................................................................................................... 3 20
3.3.15. Toner Duct Drive Unit.................................................................................................. 3 21
3.3.16. Toner Supply Drive Unit ............................................................................................... 3 21
3.3.17. Toner Duct ................................................................................................................. 3 22
3.3.18. Waste Toner Container sensor ........................................................................................ 3 22
3.3.19. Auto Size Sensor ......................................................................................................... 3 23
3.3.20. Exit Unit.................................................................................................................... 3 23
3.3.21. Eraser PBA ................................................................................................................ 3 24
3.3.22. Side Unit ................................................................................................................... 3 25

iii Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


Contents

3.3.22.1. Fuser out sensor ............................................................................................ 3 26


3.3.22.2. Temperature sensor and Duplex sensor .............................................................. 3 27
3.3.22.3. MP unit ....................................................................................................... 3 28
3.3.23. Fuser unit................................................................................................................... 3 32
3.3.24. Pick-Up Unit and sensor ............................................................................................... 3 36
3.3.25. Pick-Up sensor............................................................................................................ 3 37
3.3.26. Feed Unit................................................................................................................... 3 38
3.3.27. Registration(Regi.) Unit ............................................................................................... 3 39
3.3.28. DADF Unit ................................................................................................................ 3 40
3.3.28.1. DADF Cover................................................................................................ 3 41
3.3.28.2. DADF Open Cover........................................................................................ 3 42
3.3.28.3. DADF Stacker .............................................................................................. 3 43
3.3.28.4. DADF Main board ........................................................................................ 3 43
3.3.28.5. DADF motor_solenoid_clutch ......................................................................... 3 44
3.3.28.6. DADF Regi_Cover_Detect sensor .................................................................... 3 46
3.3.28.7. DADF Exit Idle sensor ................................................................................... 3 46
3.3.28.8. DADF Exit sensor ......................................................................................... 3 47
3.3.28.9. DADF Length_Width sensor ........................................................................... 3 47
3.3.29. Scanner Unit............................................................................................................... 3 48
3.3.29.1. Scanner joint board........................................................................................ 3 48
3.3.29.2. Scan glass .................................................................................................... 3 49
3.3.29.3. APS sensor .................................................................................................. 3 50
3.3.29.4. FR module ................................................................................................... 3 51
3.3.29.5. Scanner Assy................................................................................................ 3 52
3.3.30. Side Cover Open Switch ............................................................................................... 3 53
3.3.31. Front Cover Open Switch.............................................................................................. 3 54
3.3.32. Hard Disk Drive (HDD)................................................................................................ 3 55
3.3.32.1. Installing the HDD ........................................................................................ 3 55
3.3.32.2. Replacing the HDD ....................................................................................... 3 56
3.3.33. DCF (Double Cassette Feeder) ....................................................................................... 3 57
3.3.33.1. DCF main board ........................................................................................... 3 57
3.3.33.2. DCF Feed Motor ........................................................................................... 3 58
3.3.33.3. DCF Pick Up Motor....................................................................................... 3 58
3.3.34. Finisher ..................................................................................................................... 3 59
3.3.34.1. Finisher Main Motor ...................................................................................... 3 59
3.3.34.2. Finisher Board .............................................................................................. 3 62
4. Troubleshooting ..................................................................................................................................4 1
4.1. Control panel ............................................................................................................................4 1
4.1.1. Introducing the display screen and useful buttons ................................................................4 2
4.2. Understanding the status LED ......................................................................................................4 4

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. iv


Contents

4.3. Updating Firmware ....................................................................................................................4 5


4.3.1. Updating from the Printer Control Panel ............................................................................4 5
4.3.2. Updating from the Network ............................................................................................4 7
4.4. Service Mode (Tech Mode)........................................................................................................ 4 10
4.4.1. Entering/Exiting Service Mode ...................................................................................... 4 10
4.4.2. Service Mode Menu Tree ............................................................................................. 4 11
4.4.3. Information ................................................................................................................ 4 15
4.4.3.1. General ....................................................................................................... 4 15
4.4.3.2. Supply Status ............................................................................................... 4 15
4.4.3.3. Software Version........................................................................................... 4 16
4.4.3.4. Service Hours ............................................................................................... 4 16
4.4.3.5. Fault Log..................................................................................................... 4 16
4.4.3.6. Print Reports ................................................................................................ 4 17
4.4.3.7. Export Reports.............................................................................................. 4 17
4.4.4. Maintenance Counts..................................................................................................... 4 18
4.4.4.1. Fault Count ................................................................................................. 4 18
4.4.4.2. Jam Count ................................................................................................... 4 18
4.4.4.3. Part Replacement Count ................................................................................. 4 19
4.4.4.4. Finisher Handling Count................................................................................. 4 20
4.4.5. Diagnostics ................................................................................................................ 4 21
4.4.5.1. Engine Diagnostics........................................................................................ 4 21
4.4.5.2. Fax Diagnostics ............................................................................................ 4 25
4.4.5.3. Scanner Diagnostics....................................................................................... 4 27
4.4.5.4. Adjustment .................................................................................................. 4 29
4.4.5.5. ACS (Auto Color Sensing) ............................................................................. 4 36
4.4.6. Service Functions ........................................................................................................ 4 37
4.4.6.1. Main Memory Clear ...................................................................................... 4 37
4.4.6.2. Hard Disk Maintenance .................................................................................. 4 37
4.4.6.3. Count Setting of Large Page ........................................................................... 4 37
4.4.6.4. Debug Log................................................................................................... 4 38
4.4.6.5. Capture Log ................................................................................................. 4 38
4.4.6.6. System Recovery .......................................................................................... 4 39
4.4.6.7. TR Control Mode .......................................................................................... 4 43
4.5. Error Code and Troubleshooting ................................................................................................. 4 44
4.5.1. Ax-xxxx type error code ............................................................................................... 4 50
4.5.2. Cx-xxxx type error code ............................................................................................... 4 62
4.5.3. Hx-xxxx type error code ............................................................................................... 4 77
4.5.4. H2-xxxx (Finisher) type error code ................................................................................. 4 89
4.5.5. Mx-xxxx type error code............................................................................................. 4 102
4.5.6. Sx-xxxx type error code.............................................................................................. 4 122

v Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


Contents

4.5.7. Ux-xxxx type error code ............................................................................................. 4 144


4.6. Image quality problems and solutions ........................................................................................ 4 162
4.6.1. Vertical Black Lines................................................................................................... 4 165
4.6.2. Vertical Light or White Lines....................................................................................... 4 167
4.6.3. Horizontal Periodic Black Lines, Dots. .......................................................................... 4 169
4.6.4. Horizontal Periodic Light/Dark Lines, Dots. ................................................................... 4 170
4.6.5. Blurred image ........................................................................................................... 4 171
4.6.6. Foggy image............................................................................................................. 4 172
4.6.7. Light image .............................................................................................................. 4 173
4.6.8. Uneven pitch and jitter image ...................................................................................... 4 174
4.6.9. Skewed image........................................................................................................... 4 175
4.6.10. Poor fusing performance ............................................................................................. 4 176
4.6.11. Stain on the paper back side......................................................................................... 4 177
4.7. Adjusting the DADF skew....................................................................................................... 4 178
4.8. Other errors .......................................................................................................................... 4 179
5. System Diagram..................................................................................................................................5 1
5.1. Connection Diagram1 .................................................................................................................5 1
5.2. Connection Diagram2 .................................................................................................................5 2
5.3. Connection Diagram3 .................................................................................................................5 3
5.4. Connection Diagram4 .................................................................................................................5 4
6. Reference Information..........................................................................................................................6 1
6.1. Tools for Troubleshooting............................................................................................................6 1
6.2. Glossary...................................................................................................................................6 3

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. vi


1. Precautions

1. Precautions
In order to prevent accidents and damages to the equipment please read the precautions listed below carefully before
servicing the product and follow them closely.

1.1. Safety warning

1) Only to be serviced by a factory trained service technician.


High voltages and lasers inside this product are dangerous. This product should only be serviced by a factory trained
service technician.

2) Use only Samsung replacement parts.


There are no user serviceable parts inside the product. Do not make any unauthorized changes or additions to the
product as these could cause the product to malfunctions and create an electric shocks or fire hazards.

3) Laser Safety Statement


The printer is certified in the U.S. to conform to the requirements of DHHS 21 CFR, chapter 1 Subchapter J for
Class I(1) laser products, and elsewhere is certified as a Class I laser product conforming to the requirements of IEC
60825-1. Class I laser products are not considered to be hazardous. The laser system and printer are designed so
there is never any human access to laser radiation above a Class I level during normal operation, user maintenance
or prescribed service condition.

Wavelength : 788 nm (-13/+12)

Beam divergence
- Paraller : 10.5 degrees (-3.5/+1.5)
- Perpendicular : 31 degrees (-6/+4)

Maximum power of energy output : 10 mW

WARNING

Never operate or service the product with the protective cover removed from Laser/Scanner assembly. The reflected
beam, although invisible, can damage your eyes.
When using this product, these basic safety precautions should always be followed to reduce risk of fire, electric shock,
and personal injury.

1-1 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


1. Precautions

1.2. Caution for safety

1.2.1. Toxic material

This product contains toxic materials that could cause illness if ingested.

1) Please keep imaging unit and toner cartridge away from children. The toner powder contained in the imaging unit and
toner cartridge may be harmful, and if swallowed, you should contact a doctor.

1.2.2. Electric shock and fire safety precautions

Failure to follow the following instructions could cause electric shock or potentially cause a fire.

1) Use only the correct voltage, failure to do so could damage the product and potentially cause a fire or electric shock.

2) Use only the power cable supplied with the product. Use of an incorrectly specified cable could cause the cable to
overheat and potentially cause a fire.

3) Do not overload the power socket, this could lead to overheating of the cables inside the wall and could lead to a fire.

4) Do not allow water or other liquids to spill into the product, this can cause electric shock. Do not allow paper clips, pins
or other foreign objects to fall into the product, these could cause a short circuit leading to an electric shock or fire hazard.

5) Never touch the plugs on either end of the power cable with wet hands, this can cause electric shock. When servicing
the product, remove the power plug from the wall socket.

6) Use caution when inserting or removing the power cord. When removing the power cord, grip it firmly and pull. The
power cord must be inserted completely, otherwise a poor contact could cause overheating leading to a fire.

7) Take care of the power cable. Do not allow it to become twisted, bent sharply around corners or power cable may be
damaged. Do not place objects on top of the power cable. If the power cable is damaged it could overheat and cause a
fire. Exposed cables could cause an electric shock. Replace the damaged power cable immediately, do not reuse or
repair the damaged cable. Some chemicals can attack the coating on the power cable, weakening the cover or exposing
cables causing fire and shock risks.

8) Ensure that the power sockets and plugs are not cracked or broken in any way. Any such defects should be repaired
immediately. Take care not to cut or damage the power cable or plugs when moving the machine.

9) Use caution during thunder or lightning storms. Samsung recommends that this machine be disconnected from the
power source when such weather conditions are expected. Do not touch the machine or the power cord if it is still
connected to the wall socket in these weather conditions.

10) Avoid damp or dusty areas, install the product in a clean well ventilated location. Do not position the machine near a
humidifier or in front of an air conditioner. Moisture and dust built up inside the machine can lead to overheating and
cause a fire or cause parts to rust.

11) Do not position the product in direct sunlight. This will cause the temperature inside the product to rise possibly leading
to the product failing to work properly and in extreme conditions could lead to a fire.

12) Do not insert any metal objects into the machine through the ventilator fan or other part of the casing, it could make
contact with a high voltage conductor inside the machine and cause an electric shock.

13) When replacing the SMPS board, please wait 5 minutes after unplugging the power cord, then replace it. You
can get a shock by the electric discharge.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 1-2


1. Precautions

1.2.3. Handling precautions

The following instructions are for your own personal safety to avoid injury and so as not to damage the product.

1) Ensure the product is installed on a level surface, capable of supporting its weight. Failure to do so could cause
the product to tip or fall.

2) The product contains many rollers, gears and fans. Take great care to ensure that you do not catch your fingers, hair or
clothing in any of these rotating devices.

3) Do not place any small metal objects, containers of water, chemicals or other liquids close to the product which if spilled
could get into the machine and cause damage or a shock or fire hazard.

4) Do not install the machine in areas with high dust or moisture levels, beside on open window or close to a humidifier or
heater. Damage could be caused to the product in such areas.

5) Do not place candles, burning cigarettes, etc on the product, These could cause a fire.

1.2.4. Assembly and Disassembly precautions

1) Replace parts carefully and always use Samsung parts. Take care to note the exact location of parts and also cable
routing before dismantling any part of the machine. Ensure all parts and cables are replaced correctly. Please carry out
the following procedures before dismantling the product or replacing any parts.

2) Ensure that power is disconnected before servicing or replacing any electrical parts.

3) Disconnect interface cables and power cables.

4) Only use approved spare parts. Ensure that part number, product name, any voltage, current or temperature rating
are correct.

5) When removing or re-fitting any parts do not use excessive force, especially when fitting screws into plastic.

6) Take care not to drop any small parts into the machine.

7) Handling of the OPC Drum

The OPC Drum can be irreparably damaged if it exposed to light. Take care not to expose the OPC Drum either
to direct sunlight or to fluorescent or incandescent room lighting. Exposure for as little as 5 minutes can damage
the surface of the photoconductive properties and will result in print quality degradation. Take extra care when
servicing the product. Remove the OPC Drum and store it in a black bag or other lightproof container. Take
care when working with the Covers (especially the top cover) open as light is admitted to the OPC area and can
damage the OPC Drum.

Take care not to scratch the green surface of OPC Drum Unit. If the green surface of the Drum Cartridge is
scratched or touched the print quality will be compromised.

1-3 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


1. Precautions

1.2.5. Disregarding this warning may cause bodily injury

1) Be careful with the high temperature part.


The fuser unit works at a high temperature. Use caution when working on the printer. Wait for the fuser unit to
cool down before disassembly.

2) Do not put fingers or hair into the rotating parts.


When operating a printer, do not put hand or hair into the rotating parts (Paper feeding entrance, motor, fan, etc.).
If do, you can get harm.

3) When you move the printer, use safe lifting and handling techniques.
This printer is heavy. Use the lifting handles located on each side of the machine. Back injury could be caused if
you do not lift carefully.

4) Ensure the printer is installed safely.


Ensure the printer is installed on a level surface, capable of supporting its weight. Failure to do so could cause the
printer to tip or fall possibly causing personal injury or damaging the printer.

5) Do not install the printer on a sloping or unstable surface. After installation, double check that the printer is stable.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 1-4


1. Precautions

1.3. ESD precautions

Certain semiconductor devices can be easily damaged by static electricity. Such components are commonly called
Electrostatically Sensitive (ES) Devices or ESDs. Examples of typical ESDs are: integrated circuits, some field effect
transistors, and semiconductor chip components. The techniques outlined below should be followed to help reduce the
incidence of component damage caused by static electricity.

CAUTION

Be sure no power is applied to the chassis or circuit, and observe all other safety precautions.

1) Immediately before handling a semiconductor component or semiconductor-equipped assembly, drain off any
electrostatic charge on your body by touching a known earth ground. Alternatively, employ a commercially available
wrist strap device, which should be removed for your personal safety reasons prior to applying power to the unit
under test.

2) After removing an electrical assembly equipped with ESDs, place the assembly on a conductive surface, such as
aluminum or copper foil, or conductive foam, to prevent electrostatic charge buildup in the vicinity of the assembly.

3) Use only a grounded tip soldering iron to solder or desolder ESDs.

4) Use only an anti-static solder removal device. Some solder removal devices not classified as anti-static can
generate electrical charges sufficient to damage ESDs.

5) Do not use Freon-propelled chemicals. When sprayed, these can generate electrical charges sufficient to damage ESDs.

6) Do not remove a replacement ESD from its protective packaging until immediately before installing it. Most
replacement ESDs are packaged with all leads shorted together by conductive foam, aluminum foil, or a comparable
conductive material.

7) Immediately before removing the protective shorting material from the leads of a replacement ESD, touch the protective
material to the chassis or circuit assembly into which the device will be installed.

8) Maintain continuous electrical contact between the ESD and the assembly into which it will be installed, until
completely plugged or soldered into the circuit.

9) Minimize bodily motions when handling unpackaged replacement ESDs. Normal motions, such as the brushing together
of clothing fabric and lifting ones foot from a carpeted floor, can generate static electricity sufficient to damage an ESD.

1-5 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

2. Product Specifications and Description

2.1. Product Overview

Printing Speed (Mono/Color)


SCX-8128 series
- Up to 28 ppm in A4 (28 ppm in Letter)
- Up to 14 ppm in A3 (14 ppm in 11x17)
SCX-8123 series
- Up to 23 ppm in A4 (23 ppm in Letter)
- Up to 12 ppm in A3 (12 ppm in 11x17)
Processor
Dual Core 1GHz
Memory
768 MB DDR3 SDRAM

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-1


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.2. Specifications

Product Specifications are subject to change without notice.

2.2.1. General Specification

Item Specfication
ND model : Platen cover model
Configuration
NA model : DADF model
Operating 10 ~ 32 C (50 ~ 90 F)
Temperature
Storage -20 ~ 40 C (-4 ~ 104 F)
Operating 20~80% RH
Humidity
Storage 10~90% RH
Printing Simplex / SCX-8128 series : 50/52 dB
Duplex SCX-8123 series : 49/51 dB
Acoustic Noise SCX-8128 series : 53/55 dB
Copying Simplex /
Level (Sound Power
Duplex SCX-8123 series : 53/55 dB
/ Pressure)
Standby 30 dB
Sleep 27 dB
Europe : AC 220-240V(-10%~6%) / 5A
Input Voltage USA : AC 110~127V (-10%~6%) / 10A
Power Supply
Korea : AC 220-240V(-10%~6%) / 5A
Rated Frequency 50 / 60 Hz
Ready 100 Watt
AVG. (Normal
800 Watt
Power Consumption Operation)
Max/Peak < 1500 Watt max
Sleep/Power Off 3 Watt / 0 Watt
560 x 600 x 737.3 mm (22 x 23.6 x 29 inches) (includes Platen Cover)
560 x 600 x 794.3 mm (22 x 23.6 x 31.3 inches) (includes DADF)
Dimension (W x D x
Set (mm) 560 x 600 x 999.6 mm (22 x 23.6 x 39.2 inches) (includes Platen Cover,
H)
Stand)
560 x 600 x 1053.6 mm (22 x 23.6 x 41.5 inches) (includes DADF, DCF)
Basic machine : 48.8 Kg (107.6 lb)
Platen Cover : 2.4 Kg (5.3 lb)
DADF : 4.9 Kg (10.8 lb)
DCF : 19.5 Kg (43 lb)
Weight Set (Kg)
Stand : 12 Kg (26.5 lb)
Job Separator : 1.5 Kg (3.3 lb)
Inner Finisher : 8.5 Kg (18.7 lb)
Drum Unit + Developer Unit + Toner Cartridges : 3 Kg (6.6 lb)

2-2 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

Item Specfication
Reliability & Service Recommended SCX-8128 series : 5,000 sheets/month
Printing Volume SCX-8123 series : 3,500 sheets/month
(AMPV)
Max. Monthly Print 100,000 sheets/month
Volume

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-3


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.2.2. Print Specifications

Item Specification
SCX-8128 series
Up to 28 ppm in A4 (28 ppm in Letter)
Up to 14 ppm in A3 (14 ppm in 11X17)
Simplex
SCX-8123 series
Up to 23 ppm in A4 (23 ppm in Letter)
Up to 12 ppm in A3 (12 ppm in 11X17)
Engine Speed
SCX-8128 series
Up to 20 ipm in A4 (20 ppm in Letter)
Up to 10 ipm in A3 (10 ppm in 11X17)
Duplex
SCX-8123 series
Up to 16 ipm in A4 (16 ppm in Letter)
Up to 8 ipm in A3 (8 ppm in 11X17)
SCX-8128 series : Less than 8 sec
From Ready
SCX-8123 series : Less than 9 sec
FPOT SCX-8128 series : Less than 28 sec
From Sleep
SCX-8123 series : Less than 29 sec
From Coldboot Less than 60 sec
Optical 600 x 600 dpi
Draft : 600 x 600dpi Output (600 x 600 x 1bit)
Resolution
Enhanced Normal : 2400 x 600dpi Effective Output (600 x 600 x 2bit)
Best : 9600 x 600dpi Effective Output (600 x 600 x 4bit)
Printer Languages PCL5e, PCL6(XL), PostScript Level3, TIFF, PDF 1.4, JPEG
Fonts PCL:93 scalable, 1 bitmap, OCR-A, OCR-B, PS:136
Downloadable Fonts Yes (PCL & PS3 S/W Font)
Secure Printing No
Proof printing No
Print Job (with HDD
Spool No
)
Stored Printing No
Form overlays No
USB Memory Direct Print Jpeg, Tiff, PDF, Samsung PRN, MTIFF, TXT

2-4 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.2.3. Controller and Software specification

Item Specification
MPU Chorus4N Dual Core 1GHz
Processor
Image Processor Embedded in Chorus4N
768MB DDR3 SDRAM
Std.
(512MB for System + 256MB for GUI)
DRAM
768MB DDR3 SDRAM
Max.
(512MB for System + 256MB for GUI)
Memory Expansion N.A.
Storage 320GB HDD (Optional)
[Windows]
Windows 2000/ XP(32/64bit)/ 2003(32/64bit)/ Vista(32/64bit)/ 2008/
Win7/ 2008 R2(64 only)
[Linux]
RedHat Enterprise Linux WS 4, 5 (32/64bit)
Fedora 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13 (32/64bit)
SuSE Linux 10.1 (32bit)
Supporting OS
OpenSuSE 10.2 10.3, 11.0, 11.1, 11.2 (32/64bit)
Mandriva 2007, 2008, 2009, 2009.1, 2010 (32/64bit)
Ubuntu 6.06, 6.10, 7.04, 7.10, 8.04 8.10, 9.04, 9.10, 10.04 (32/64bit)
SuSE Linux Enterprise Desktop 10, 11 (32/64bit)
Debian 4.0, 5.0 (32/64bit)
[Mac]
Mac OS X 10.5 ~ 10.7
Default Driver PCL6 (For Windows), PS (for Mac, Linux)
Printer driver [Windows]
Watermark, Overlay, N-up printing, Poster printing
Duplex, Quality, Color mode (Color, Gray scale)
Driver feature Support Color spec., Device color, color management
[Mac/Linux]
N-up printing, Duplex, Quality
Color mode (Color, Gray scale)
WHQL
(Windows Hardware Windows 2000/XP(include 64bit)/2003/Vista/2008/Win7/2008 R2(64 only)
Quality Labs)
23 countries( Arabic/ Portuguese Brazilian/ Simplified Chinese / Traditional
Language Chinese/ Czech/ Danish/ Dutch/ Greek/ English/ Finnish/ French/ German/
Localization Hebrew/ Hungarian/ Italian/ Korea/ Norweigian/ Polish/ Portuguese / Russian/
Spanish / Swedish /Turkish)
Status Monitor (Lite
Yes (Windows Only)
SM)
UPD (SSPD) Yes

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-5


2. Product Specifications and Description

Item Specification
TWAIN Yes
WIA No
[Windows]
Windows 2000/ XP(32/64bit)/ 2003(32/64bit)/ Vista(32/64bit)/
2008(32/64bit)/ Win7/ 2008 R2(64 only)
[Linux]
RedHat Enterprise Linux WS 4, 5 (32/64bit)
Scan driver Fedora 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13 (32/64bit) - SuSE Linux 10.1 (32bit)
Supporting OS OpenSuSE 10.2 10.3, 11.0, 11.1, 11.2 (32/64bit)
Mandriva 2007, 2008, 2009, 2009.1, 2010 (32/64bit)
Ubuntu 6.06, 6.10, 7.04, 7.10, 8.04 8.10, 9.04, 9.10, 10.04 (32/64bit)
SuSE Linux Enterprise Desktop 10, 11 (32/64bit)
Debian 4.0, 5.0 (32/64bit)
[Mac]
Mac OS X 10.5 ~ 10.6
Scan Manager Yes (Win, Mac)
Scan Assistant Yes (Win, Mac)
PC-FAX No
Network-FAX No
Samsung Easy
Yes (Win, Mac)
Printer Manager
Application
Network Set IP, SWAS 5.0 & SWS 2.0 SWAS Plug-In : Job Accounting, Storage
Management management, Cloning, Remote Install
HDD File
No
Management S/W
AnyWeb Print Yes
SmarThru Smarthru Office, SmarThru Workflow(Optional)

Interface
Item Specification
Parallel (IEEE 1284) No
Type A, Host High-Speed USB 2.0 Host (2-port)
USB
Type B, Device Hi-Speed USB 2.0 Peripheral (1-port)
Wired LAN Ethernet 10/100/1000 Base TX
Wireless LAN No
Foreign Device Interface Optional

2-6 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

Network Interface
Item Specification
Microsoft Windows 2000/ XP(32/64bits)/ 2003(32/64bits)/
Vista(32/64bits)/ Win7
[Mac]
Mac OS X 10.5 ~ 10.6
[Linux]
RedHat 8 ~ 9
Network OS Fedora Core 1~4
Madrake 9.2 ~ 10.1
SuSE 8.2 ~ 9.2
[Novell]
Netware 5.x, 6.x(TCP/IP Only)
[Others]
Unix(HP-UX,Solaris,SunOS, SCO)
TCP/IPv4, HTTP, SNMPv1/v2c/v3, LDAP, SMTP, SSL/TLS, IPSec,
TCP/IP
DNS,WINS, SLP, Bonjour, SSDP,DDNS, DHCP/BOOTP,IPv6
IPX/SPX No
Network Protocols Ether Talk No
NetBIOS over
Yes
TCP/IP
Others HTTPS, LDAPS, IPSec, 802.1x
Static IP Yes
Auto IP Yes
IP Addressing
BOOTP Yes
DHCP Yes

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-7


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.2.4. Scan specification

Item Specification
Scan method Color CCDM-MMT
Compatibility TWAIN(N/W)
Color Mode Mono / Gray / Color
ScanToEmail/SMB/FTP : 45ipm @ 300dpi
B/W (Lineart, Halftone) PC scan : 15sec @300dpi
(@P4-3GHz, 1G, NW 100M, A4LEF)
ScanToEmail/SMB/FTP : 45ipm @ 300dpi
Scan Speed Gray PC scan : 20sec @300dpi
(@P4-3GHz, 1G, NW 100M, A4LEF)
ScanToEmail/SMB/FTP : 45ipm @ 300dpi
Color PC scan : 30sec @300dpi
(@P4-3GHz, 1G, NW 100M, A4LEF)
Optical 600 x 600 ppi
Resolution
Enhanced 4,800 x 4,800 ppi
Halftone 256 levels
Max. Document Width Max. 297mm (11.7")
Scan Size Effective Scan Width Max. 291mm
Max. Document Length Max. 432mm
Color 24 bits
Scan Depth 1bit for Linearity & Halftone
Mono
8Bits for Gray scale
NA: Platen & DADF
Scan Depth
ND: Platen Only
HDD Yes (Optional)
USB Yes
Email Yes
Client Yes (N/W)
Scan-to SMB Yes
FTP Yes
HTTP(S) No
WebDAV No
Multi Destination No
User Based Individual (Fax+Email+Server) : 200
Email, Fax, Server
Group : (Fax+Email) : 200
Searching
Address Book Editing
Basic Feature Deleting
Grouping
import, export

2-8 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

Item Specification
Mixed Document Yes
Scan Preset No
Delayed Send No
Job Done notice No
Scan Setting
Recent Yes
OCR No
Job Build No
Book Scan No

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-9


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.2.5. Copy specification

Item Specification
SCX-8128 series
Simplex : up to 28 cpm in A4 & Letter
SDMC (Single Duplex : up to 20 cpm in A4 & Letter
Document Multiple
Copy) SCX-8123 series
Simplex : up to 23 cpm in A4 & Letter
Duplex : up to 16 cpm in A4 & Letter
Copy Speed (DADF)
SCX-8128 series
Simplex-to-Duplex(1-2): up to 20 cpm in A4 & Letter
MDMC (Multiple Duplex -to-Duplex(2-2): up to 16 cpm in A4 & Letter
Document Multiple
Copy) SCX-8123 series
Simplex-to-Duplex(1-2): up to 16 cpm in A4 & Letter
Duplex -to-Duplex(2-2): up to 16 cpm in A4 & Letter
SCX-8128 series : Less than 5.7 seconds (from platen)
From Ready
SCX-8123 series : Less than 6.7 seconds (from platen)
FCOT SCX-8128 series : Less than 26 seconds (from platen)
From Sleep
SCX-8123 series : Less than 27 seconds (from platen)
From Coldboot Less than 60 seconds (from platen)
Zoom Range 25% ~ 400% in 1% increments (Platen/DADF)
Multi Copy 1~9999
Platen: Scan 600 x 600 dpi, Printing 600 x 600 x 2bit
Text
DADF : Scan 600 x 600 dpi, Printing 600 x 600 x 2bit
Platen: Scan 600 x 600dpi, Printing 600 x 600 x 2bit
Text/Photo
DADF : Scan 600 x 600dpi, Printing 600 x 600 x 2bit
Magazine No
Platen: Scan 600 x 600 dpi, Printing 600 x 600 x 4bit
Photo
Original Type DADF : Scan 600 x 600 dpi, Printing 600 x 600 x 4bit
Platen: Scan 600 x 600 dpi, Printing 600 x 600 x 2bit
Copied Original
DADF : Scan 600 x 600 dpi, Printing 600 x 600 x 2bit
Platen: Scan 600 x 600 dpi, Printing 600 x 600 x 2bit
Map
DADF : Scan 600 x 600 dpi, Printing 600 x 600 x 2bit
Platen: Scan 600 x 600dpi, Printing 600 x 600 x 2bit
Light Original
DADF : Scan 600 x 600dpi, Printing 600 x 600 x 2bit
Original Type Factory Default Mono Copy Text/Photo (Mixed) Mode
Auto Color No
Full Color No
Color Setting Twin Color No
Single Color No
B&W Yes
Platen 297 x 432 mm (11.7" x 17")
Max. Original Size
DADF 297 x 432 mm (11.7" x 17")

2-10 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

Item Specification
Multi Copy 1~9999
Automatic Paper
Yes
Selection
Manual Paper
Yes
Selection
NA: Platen & DADF
Multi-page Copy
ND: Platen Only
Using Platen
11Sided
12Sided (Output : Book, Calendar)
Basic Copy
Using DADF
Duplex Copy
11Sided
12Sided (Output: Book, Calendar)
21Sided (Original: Book, Calendar)
22Sided (Original: Book, Calendar, Output: Book, Calendar)
Darkness Control 11 Levels
Collation Copy Yes (Limited)
* Zoom Range : 25% to 400% in Platen and DADF
Reduce & Enlarge * Preset: [Original(100%)] [Auto Fit] 25%, 50%, 150%, 200%, 400%
[Custom:25-400%)]
Proof Copy No
N-Up 2up ~ 32 up
ID Card Copy Yes (Platen only)
Poster Copy No
Clone Copy (Image No
Other Features Repeat)
Booklet No
Covers Yes
Transparencies No
Book Copy Yes (Platen only)
Scan to Document No
Erase Edge No
Margin Shift No
Book Center Erase Yes
Form Copy No
Watermark Copy Yes
Image Stamp Yes
Job Program Yes
Adjust Background Auto, Erase(4 levels), Enhance(2 levels)
Job Build No
Rotation Copy No
Mirror No

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-11


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.2.6. Fax specification

Item Specification
Compatibility ITU-T G3, Super G3
Communication System PSTN/PABX
Modem Speed 33.6Kbps
TX Speed 3 sec (Mono/Standard/ECM-MMR, ITU-T G3 No.1 Chart,A4)
Compression MH/MR/MMR/JBIG
Color Fax No
ECM Yes
Std 203*98dpi
Fine 203*196dpi
Resolution (Mono) S.Fine Photo No
S.Fine 300*300dpi
Ultra Fine 600*600dpi
Std 1.5 sec/LTR
Scan speed Fine 4 sec/LTR
S.Fine Depends on Document
Handset No
On hook Dial Yes
Search Yes (Phone Book)
Speed Dial 500 locations
Group Dial Max. 100 Groups (Max. locations per 1 Group : 100 locations)
TAD I/F Yes
Telephone Features Tone/Pulse Yes
Pause Yes
Auto Redial Yes
Redial Yes
Distinctive Ring No
Caller ID Yes
External Phone Interface Yes
Mail Box No
Voice Request No
TTI Yes
RTI Yes
Polling No
Functions Earth/Recall No
Auto Reduction Yes
SMS No
Multi-send up to 505 locations
Delayed Send Yes
Memory RX Yes

2-12 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

Item Specification
Secure Rx Yes
Time Secured Fax Yes
Relay Transmission (ITU-T
No
Mail Box)
Priority Transmission No
Batch Transmission No
Searching Yes
Storing Yes
Editing Yes
Address Book Basic Feature Deleting Yes
Grouping Yes
Chaining No
import, export Yes
Search condition No
Favorites Button No
Address Book Advanced Curent Sending , Receiving
Yes (Curent Sending )
Tel number
LDAP Yes
Check the Success or Fail &
Yes
Error
Re-Faxing from memory in
Yes
case of failed Fax
Sending fax Management
Re-Faxing in case of failed
Yes
page.
Delete in memory after
Yes
sending completely
Separator Sheet No
Insert the stamp Yes (Option -On,Off) Rx Time ,ID, Page
Fax Receiving Feature/
Number of Printing Copies No
Printing the Rx Document
Revers order printing No
tray selection Yes
Tx/Rx Journal Yes
Confirmation 2 type (Image TCR or w/o Image TCR)
Report & List Print out
Auto Dial List No
System Data List No
Ring Volume Yes (7 steps and mute)
Key Volume Yes (7 steps and mute)
Sound Control
Speaker Yes (7 steps and mute)
Alarm Volume Yes (7 steps and mute)
Junk Fax barrier No
Security Receive Yes
Battery Backup Permanently stored on HDD

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-13


2. Product Specifications and Description

Item Specification
Send Yes
Duplex
Receive Yes
Receive Mode Fax, TEL, Ans/Fax
Battery Backup HDD Store, 500 jobs
Fax Forward to FAX No
Fax Forward to e-mail Yes
Broadcasting up to 505 locations
Cover page No
HDD Yes
USB No
Fax No
Email Yes
Fax-to Client No
SMB Yes
FTP Yes
HTTP(S) No
Multi-destination No

2-14 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.2.7. Paper Handling specification

Item Specification
1,140 sheets @ 20 lb or 80 g/m
Standard Capacity 520-sheet cassette Tray (20 lb or 80 g/m) x 2
100-sheet MP tray (20 lb or 80 g/m)
Max. Input Capacity MP + Tray x 4 2,180 sheets @ 20 lb or 80 g/m
Max. Size 297 x 432 mm (11.7" x 17"), Banner
Printing Min. Size 98 x 148 mm (3.85" x 5.83")
Margin(T/B/L/R) 4.2+/-1.5mm
Capacity Plain Paper: 100 sheets @ 80 g/m
Envelopes: 10 sheets @ 75 g/m
Labels: 20 sheets @ 120~150 g/m
Thick Paper: 10 sheets @ 176 g/m
Media sizes 98 x 148 mm ~ 297 x 432 mm (3.87 x 5.8" ~ 11.7 x 17")
Banner Size Printing : 297 mm x 1200 mm
MP Tray
Media type Printer Default, Plain Paper, Thick Paper, Thin Paper, Bond Paper, Color Paper,
CardStock, Labels, Envelope, Preprinted, Letterhead, Recycled Paper, Cotton,
Archive, Glossy
Media weight 16 ~ 47 lb (60 to 176 g/m) : Simplex, Duplex
Sensing Paper Empty Detect : Yes
Paper Size Detect : Yes
Capacity 520 sheets @ 20 lb (80g/m) X 2
Legder, A3, Letter, Legal, Oficio, Folio, A3, A4, JIS B5, ISO B5, Executive,
Media sizes
A5, Statement, Custom
Plain Paper, Thin Paper, Bond, Punched, Pre-Printed, Recycled, Label,
Media types
CardStock, Letterhead, Thick, Cotton, Colored, Archive, Glossy
Plain Paper: 71~90g/m(19~24 lb), (Duplex : 19~24lb)
Thick Paper: 91~105g/m(25~28 lb), (Duplex : 25~28lb)
Heavy Weight 1 Paper : 106~120g/m
Heavy Weight 2 Paper : 121~175g/m
Extra Heavy Weight 1 Paper : 176 ~ 216g/m
Thin Paper: 60~70g/m(16~18 lb)
Standard Cassette
Bond Paper: 105~120g/m (28~32 lb)
Tray Media weight
Punched Paper: 71~90g/m (19~24 lb)
Pre-Printed : 75~90g/m (20~24 lb)
Recycled : 60~90g/m (16~24 lb)
CardStock : 105~163g/m (28~43lb)
Letterhead : 71~90g/m (19~24lb)
Cotton paper : 75~90g/m (20~24lb)
Label : 120~150g/m (32~40 lb)
H/W Install Detect: Yes
Paper Empty & Low Level Detect: Yes
Sensing
Paper Type Detect: No
Paper Size Detect: Yes

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-15


2. Product Specifications and Description

Item Specification
Capacity 520 sheets @ 20lb (80g/m) x 2
Legder, A3, Letter, Legal, Oficio, Folio, A4, JIS B5, ISO B5, Executive, A5,
Media sizes
Statement, Custom
Plain Paper, Thin Paper, Bond, Punched, Pre-Printed, Recycled, Label,
Media types
CardStock, Letterhead, Thick, Cotton, Colored, Archive, Glossy
Plain Paper: 71~90g/m(19~24 lb), (Duplex : 19~24lb)
Thick Paper: 91~105g/m(25~28 lb), (Duplex : 25~28lb)
Heavy Weight 1 Paper : 106~120g/m
Heavy Weight 2 Paper : 121~175g/m
Extra Heavy Weight 1 Paper : 176 ~ 216g/m
Thin Paper: 60~70g/m(16~18 lb)
Optional Cassette
Bond Paper: 105~120g/m(28~32 lb)
Tray Media weight
Punched Paper: 71~90g/m(19~24 lb)
Pre-Printed : 75~90g/m(20~24 lb)
Recycled : 60~90g/m(16~24 lb)
CardStock : 105~163g/m (28~43lb)
Letterhead : 71~90g/m (19~24lb)
Cotton paper : 75~90g/m (20~24lb)
Label : 120~150g/m (32~40 lb)
H/W Install Detect: Yes
Paper Empty & Low Level Detect: Yes
Sensing
Paper Type Detect: No
Paper Size Detect: Yes
Optional High-Capacity Feeder(HCF) N/A
Capacity
500 sheets @ 20lb (80g/m)
(FaceDown)
Output Stacking
Offset Stacking No
Output Full sensing Yes
Capacity 50 sheets stapling / 350 (in total) sheets stacking, internal
Staple Cartridge
5000 staples / cartridge
capacity
Top Tray : 50 sheets with 80g/m sheet
Stacking
Finishing Tray : 300 sheets with 80g/m sheet
Standard Finisher Stapling 1 Corner (Single)
Offline Stapling No
Offset at Non Staple
No
job
Offset at Staple job Yes
Output Stacking Face Down
3250-sheet Booklet Finisher N/A
Punch Kit N/A

2-16 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

Item Specification
Supporting Yes
Legder, A3, Letter, Legal, Oficio, Folio, A3, A4, JIS B5, ISO B5, Executive,
Media sizes
A5, Statement, Custom
Automatic Duplex
Plain Paper, Thin Paper, Bond, Punched, Pre-Printed, Recycled, Label,
Media types
CardStock, Letterhead, Thick, Cotton, Colored, Archive, Glossy
Media weight 60~175g/m(16~46 lb)
Capacity 100 sheets ( 20lb, 80 g/m)
2-sided Document
Yes
Scanning
Width: 128~297mm
Document Size
Length : 128 ~ 432mm
42~163g/m @simplex
DADF Document Weight
50~128g/m @duplex
Paper empty detect : Yes
Sensing Paper width detect : Yes
Paper length detect : Yes
Auto Detected Size
A3, A4, A4 SEF, A5, A5 SEF, B4, B5, B5 SEF
Sensing

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-17


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.2.8. Consumables

Item Model Name Average yield


Toner Cartridge MLT-D709S 25,000 impressions
Drum Unit and Developer MLT-R709 100,000 impressions
Waste Toner Container MLT-W709 100,000 impressions

NOTE

Declared yield value in accordance with 5% coverage.

Depending on the print pattern and job mode used, the consumables lifespan may differ.

2.2.9. Maintenance Parts

Item Part Code Life


Developer Unit JC96-06208A 300,000 impressions
Transfer roller Assy JC95-01520A 150,000 impressions
Fuser Unit JC9101049A (110V) 150,000 impressions
JC9101050A (220V)
Pick-Up / Reverse / Forward roller (for Tray1,2,3,4, MP Tray) JC93-00540A 200,000 impressions
DADF Pick-Up roller Assy JC97-04009A 200,000 impressions
DADF Friction Pad JC97-03097A 100,000 impressions
Ozone Filter JC61-04861A 150,000 impressions

NOTE

Depending on the print patterns and job mode used, the lifespan may differ.

2-18 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.2.10. Option

SCX-8123 SCX-8128
Image Item Model
series series

DCF
CLX-PFP100/SEE Yes Yes
(Dual Cassette Feeder)

Finisher CLX-FIN50S/SEE Yes Yes

Job Separator CLX-JST100/SEE Yes Yes

CLX-FAX160/XXX

NOTE
Fax Yes Yes
XXX : SEE, XEG,
XEU, XIL

Cabinet Stand CLX-DSK20T Yes Yes

FDI Kit CLX-KIT10F Yes Yes

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-19


2. Product Specifications and Description

SCX-8123 SCX-8128
Image Item Model
series series

Working Table CLX-WKT000 Yes Yes

Card Reader Cover Assy CLX-CRH002 Yes Yes

Cassette Heater CLX-DHK12C Yes Yes

DADF unit
(Duplex Automatic SCX-ADF61D Yes Yes
Document Feeder)

HDD
SCX-HDK471 Yes Yes
(Hard Disk Drive)

SmarThru Workflow
Yes Yes
V1.0

2-20 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.3. Feeding System

2.3.1. Feeding System Overview

The feeding system picks up a paper from the cassette or MP tray and transports it to the machine inside. It mainly consists
of the pick up unit, registration unit, transfer roller Assy, Exit unit.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-21


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.3.2. Main Components and functions

a) Rollers

1 Tray 1 Paper tray 6 Tray 2 pick up / reverse / forward rollers


2 Tray 2 Paper tray 7 Tray 3 pick up / reverse / forward rollers (Option)
3 Tray 3 Paper tray(Option) 8 Tray 4 pick up / reverse / forward rollers (Option)
4 Tray 4 Paper tray(Option) 9 MP Tray pick up / reverse / forward rollers
5 Tray 1 pick up / reverse / forward rollers 10 Tray 1 feed roller

2-22 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

11 Tray 2 feed roller 17 Roller Exit 1st


12 Tray 3 feed roller (Option) 18 Roller Exit 2nd (Option)
13 Tray 4 feed roller (Option) 19 Roller Invert
14 Sensor registration 20 Roller Duplex1
15 Roller registration 21 Roller Duplex2
16 Roller transfer

Pick-Up roller (Tray 1,2,3,4 and MP Tray)


- This roller picks up the paper from the tray.
Forward roller (Tray 1,2,3,4 and MP Tray)
- This roller is placed against the reverse roller. It transports the paper from the pick up roller to feed roller.
Reverse roller (Tray 1,2,3,4 and MP Tray)
- This roller is placed against the forward roller and transports only one sheet to the feed roller. When two sheets of
paper or more are transported from the pick up roller, the load of the torque limiter of the reverse roller is heavier
than the frictional force between the sheets. As a result, the reverse roller is stopped and the lower paper does
not advance any further.
Feed roller
- This roller transports the paper sent from the forward/reverse roller to the registration roller.
Registration roller
- This roller aligns the leading edge of the paper and transports the paper to the transfer roller Assy.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-23


2. Product Specifications and Description

b) Sensor, Motor, Solenoid

2-24 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

Name Function Connector & Pin information


Tray1 paper size detection sensor Detects tray1 paper size CN4@ MAIN PBA, 19Pin
Tray1 paper empty detection sensor Detects tray1 paper empty CN27@ MAIN PBA, 3Pin
Tray1 upper limit detection sensor Detects tray1 upper limit CN27@ MAIN PBA, 6Pin
Tray2 paper size detection sensor Detects tray2 paper size CN4@ MAIN PBA, 23Pin
Tray2 paper empty detection sensor Detects tray2 paper empty CN27@ MAIN PBA, 20Pin
Tray2 upper limit detection sensor Detects tray2 upper limit CN27@ MAIN PBA, 23Pin
Paper regi. jam detection sensor Detects regi. jam CN31@ MAIN PBA, 12Pin
Paper fuser-out jam detection sensor Detects fuser unit jam CN26@ MAIN PBA, 12Pin
Exit tray1 paper full detection sensor Detects paper full on Exit tray1 CN19@ MAIN PBA, 6Pin
Exit2 tray path &Return path solenoid Change paper path CN19@ MAIN PBA, 11Pin
Duplex motor Controls duplex driving CN26@ MAIN PBA, 6Pin~9Pin
Duplex jam detection sensor Detects duplex jam CN26@ MAIN PBA, 24Pin
Exit tray 2 paper full detection sensor Detects paper full on Exit tray2 CN19@ MAIN PBA, 18Pin
MPF Paper empty detection sensor Detects MP tray paper empty CN26@ MAIN PBA, 3Pin

NOTE

Paper on MP tray is taken priority over


it on tray 1,2,3,4.

MPF solenoid Controls MPF pick up roller CN26@ MAIN PBA, 4Pin
Tray1 Lift motor Lifting Knock up plate CN27@ MAIN PBA, 10Pin~13Pin
Tray2 Lift motor Lifting Knock up plate CN27@ MAIN PBA, 14Pin~17Pin

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-25


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.3.3. Cassette (Tray 1,2,3,4)

The Cassette stores papers.

Paper size is set using the Size Guides in each tray.

Specification
1) Structure : Drawer Type

2) Capacity : 520 Sheets ( 80g/ paper standard)

3) Paper
- Plain paper : A5, A4, A3, B5, B4, Letter, 11"17"(Ledger), Statement, Legal

4) Weight : plain paper 60 ~ 216 g/m

5) Plate knock up lift type : Lift Motor + Up Limit Sensor

2-26 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.3.4. Pick-Up Unit

When pick-up takes place, the pickup roller moves down to come into contact with the surface of the paper. If the cassette is
installed, the LEVER-INPUT CST is pushed and pick up roller moves down. The forward roller and the reverse roller
serve to make sure that a single sheet of paper is moved to the paper path, and the paper is moved as far as the registration
roller by the work of the feed roller.

PickUp Unit1

PickUp Unit2

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-27


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.3.5. Registration Unit

The registration(Regi.) roller is driven by the Regi./MP motor. The Regi. clutch is located between the Regi. clutch and
Regi./MP motor, and it controls ON/OFF of the registration roller in order to match paper and an image on the drum at the
predetermined registration point.

Specification
1) Skew in simplex

Top Skew : 1.5 mm

Side Skew : 2.0 mm

2) Dog Ear, Trees, Nicks, Wrinkling

Special Media : 1/500

3) Margin

Top Margin : 4.23 1.5 mm ( Tray3, 4 : 4.23 2.0 mm )

Side Margin : 4.23 1.5 mm ( Tray3, 4 : 4.23 2.0 mm )

Duplex Top Margin : 4.23 2.0 mm ( Tray3, 4 : 4.23 2.0 mm )

Duplex Side Margin : 4.23 2.0 mm ( Tray3, 4 : 4.23 2.0 mm )

2-28 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.3.6. MPF(Multi-Purpose Feeder) Unit

The MPF Unit allows feeding of special media cardstock, envelopes, and custom size paper.

Specification
1) Capacity : 100 sheets ( 80g/m paper standard)

2) Media Size : Max 11. 7 17 (297432 ) / Min 3.875.8 (98148 )

3) Media Weight : Plain paper 60 ~ 176 g/m

4) Feeding Speed : 28 ppm (SCX-8128 series), 23 ppm (SCX-8123 series) Letter/A4 LEF (Long Edge Feeding)

Paper Separation

When the MP paper detection[A] sensor detects paper and the machine gets a MP printing job, the MP solenoid[B] drops the
pick-up roller[C] onto the top of the paper stack on the MP tray.

This machine uses an FRR (Feed and Reverse Roller) system for feeding paper. The friction between the reverse roller[E]
and forward roller[D] separates the top sheet of paper from the stack.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-29


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.4. Image Creation

2.4.1. Printing process overview

This machine uses one imaging unit and one laser beam for mono printing. Imaging unit consists of a Drum unit and
Developer unit.

Drum unit has an OPC drum, Scorotron, Cleaning blade.

The OPC drum [A] is charged with a negative voltage and is exposed by the light from the LSU (Laser Scanning unit) [B].
The light produced by a laser creates a latent image by discharging on the surface of the OPC drum. The negatively charged
toners are attracted to the latent image due to and electric filed. The toners(real image) on the OPC drum are moved to the
transfer media by the positive bias applied to the transfer roller.

1) OPC drum charge : The charge roller gives the drum a negative charge.

2) Laser exposure : Light produced by a laser diode hits the charged OPC through the lens and mirrors.

3) Development : The developing roller carries negatively charged toner to the latent image on the drum surface.

4) Transfer : The transfer roller opposite the OPC drum transfers toner from the drum to the paper.

5) Cleaning for OPC drum : The cleaning blade remove remaining toner on the drum surface after image transfer
to the paper.

6) Quenching for OPC drum : Discharge cleaning is done by illuminating the whole area of the drum with the cleaning
lamp at the end of every job.

2-30 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.4.2. Imaging Unit

2.4.2.1. Imaging Unit overview

The Imaging Unit consists of the Drum unit and the Developer unit.

The diameter of the drum is 30 mm (circumference: about 94.2 mm).

The developing gap between a drum and the corresponding magnetic roller cannot be adjusted. The ID chip is the sub part of
the Drum unit. It stores the count information and several data.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-31


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.4.2.2. Drum Drive

The OPC drum and magnetic roller are driven by one BLDC motor and supplied with power from the coupling.

The drive shaft is directly inserted to the OPC drum to fix the drum unit. This structure provides the stable printing quality.

2-32 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.4.2.3. Developer Unit

This machine uses a dual-component development system

The developer unit contains 345g of magnetic toner carrier that is supplied to the magnetic(development) roller[A] by the
two mixing augers[B]. The diameter of the magnetic roller is 18.2 mm.

The developer unit has a TC(Toner Concentration) sensor[C]. It is used for controlling the operating range of toner density.

Developer Circulation
Two mixing augers[A] circulate the developer forward and backward to agitate the developer in order to mix the developer
and toner well.

This occurs at the following times :

During the process control self-checking


During toner supply job
During development job
If the developer unit is stored at temperature above 50 degrees C, it does not works normally. The toner in developer
unit is easy to harden at temperature above 50 degrees C.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-33


2. Product Specifications and Description

2-34 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.5. Fuser unit

This section describes the image fusing process used by the machine.

2.5.1. Fuser Unit overview

This unit fuses the toner that was transferred by the transfer roller onto the paper, by applying heat and pressure to
complete fusing process. This machine applied the 2Roller fusing system and used the thinner heat roller to improve
the warm-up time.

1) Halogen Lamp
The fuser unit has two halogen lamps. One heats the center of the heat roller, the other heats the end of axial direction.
These halogen lamps are lit alternately to heat the heat roller. each lamp has its coil in a different location. The coil
of the center heater lamp is in the center, those of the side heater lamp are on both sides. The lamp s are fixed inside
of the heat roller. When rotating the heat roller, these lamps does not rotate.

2) Heat Roller
The heat roller is made of the aluminum and gets heat from the halogen lamp and transfer it to toner and paper. The
thinner heat roller reduces the warm-up time and the mode switching time. To prevent the heat roller from adhering to
the toner, its surface applied the PFA coating. The gear located the side of the heat roller rotates the roller.

3) Pressure Roller
The pressure roller is a rubber roller which ensures proper nip width between the pressure roller and heat roller. To
adhere the toner on paper effectively, the pressure roller pushes the heat roller by using the spring.

4) NC sensor
NC sensors (non-contact type thermistors), located near the center of the heat roller, control the temperature.

5) Thermistor
Thermistor detects the temperature on the surface of the heat roller and controls the halogen lamp.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-35


2. Product Specifications and Description

6) Thermostat
Thermostats cut off the power supply to the halogen lamp by opening the circuit when the heat roller becomes
abnormally hot as a result of problems such as NC sensor malfunction. These thermostats are used to prevent abnormal
operation. When the thermostat is triggered, it must be replaced (as well as the other damaged parts in the fuser unit).

2.5.2. Fuser unit drive

The fuser motor[A] drives the heat roller[C] through the gear train. The pressure roller[B] pressurized by the heat
roller[C] is rotated by driving it.

2-36 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.5.3. Fuser unit temperature control

When the main switch turns on, the CPU turns on the fusing lamp. The lamp stays on until the NC sensors detect the
standby temperature. Then the CPU raises the temperature up to the printing temperature.

Overheat Protection
The CPU cuts power to the fusing lamp in the following cases :

The temperature detected by the NC sensors keeps higher than 240C for 20 sec.
The following components are used when thermistor overheat protection fails :

Two thermostats get into line with the common ground wire of the fusing lamp.
If one of the thermostat temperatures becomes higher than 195C, it opens and cuts power to the fusing lamp. If the
other thermostat temperature becomes higher than 195C, it also opens and cuts power to the fusing lamp.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-37


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.6. Laser Scanning Unit (LSU)

2.6.1. LSU overview

LSU consists of 1 polygon motor and 1 LD unit. It forms a latent image on the surface of the OPC drum. For this process,
LSU has the collimating lens, cylindrical lens and F-Theta lens on optical path.

And LSU has the cover glass to protect the glass on the optical path from the contamination. The LD PBA interfaces
with the machine.

1 LD PBA
2 P/Mirror Motor
3 F1 Lens
4 F2 Lens
5 Cover Glass

2-38 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.6.2. Laser Scanning Optical path

The laser beam moves from the polygon motor[A] to OPC drum[D]. The F1 lens[B] and F2 lens[C] determines the scanning
line and the image position. This is adjusted at the factory.

The LSU has 2 types depending on printing speed. The difference between 2 types is shown in the table below.

SCX8123 series SCX-8128 series Remark


LD Unit Laser Diode : Single Beam Laser Diode : Single Beam
driving IC : for Single LD driving IC : for Single LD
PCB : 23/28ppm common use PCB : 23/28ppm common use
P/Motor speed 27,874 rpm 33,307 rpm
Process Speed 118 mm/sec 141 mm/sec
H/W interface Harness : 26 Pin (Interface with set Harness : 26 Pin (Interface with set FFC cable
) )

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-39


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.6.3. Laser synchronizing detectors

The LSU has the beam detector sensor board (PD PBA). It is located at [A] point and detects the scanning start point.

Main Scan Start Detection


The beam is detected by the PD PBA at the scanning start point and creates the horizontal sync signal(Hsync).

The following diagram shows the data scanning direction.

2-40 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.7. Drive System

2.7.1. Drive Motors

No. Motor Motor type Qty Function


1 Exit PM-STEP 1 Exit driving
(Reverse driving at Duplex job)
2 Fuser BLDC 1 Fuser driving/Fuser pressure mode
(Reverse driving at pressure mode)
3 OPC / DEVE BLDC 1 OPC/DEVE driving
4 Regi./ MP BLDC 1 Regi / MP/ Feed 1,2 driving
Feed 1,2 E-CLT 3 Regi / MP / Feed driving control
5 Pick-Up PM-STEP 2 Pick-Up Roll / CST Lift driving
(Reverse driving at CST Lift driving)
6 Toner Supply DC 1 Toner cartridge driving
7 Toner Duct PM-STEP 1 Toner transfer in toner cartridge driving Duct

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-41


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.7.2. Main Drive Unit (OPC_DEVE_Regi_MP_Feed)

1) Front View

2) Rear View

2-42 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

3) Main drive (OPC/ Deve)

Power Train OPC / DEVE : BLDC driving


1 2 (OPC driving)
1 3 4 (Mag. roller driving)

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-43


2. Product Specifications and Description

4) Main drive (Regi./ MP/ Feed 1,2)

Power Train Regi / MP / Feed 1,2 : BLDC driving, Clutch driving control
1 2 3 4 Clutch/Gear (Regi Input)
1 2 5 6 7 Clutch/ Gear (MP Input)
1 2 5 6 8 Clutch/ Gear (Feed1 Input) 9 10 (Feed2 Input)

2-44 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.7.3. Pick Up Drive

Power Train Pick-Up : rotating (Pick-up input) / counter rotating (Cst Lift input)
Step Gear 1 Gear 2 (Pick-up)
Step Gear 1 Gear 3 Gear 4 Gear 5 Gear 6 (CST Lift)

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-45


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.7.4. Duct Drive

Power Train Duct : PM-STEP driving


1 PM-Step 2 Gear Gear Duct driving

2-46 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.7.5. Fuser/ Exit Drive

Power Train Fuser : BLDC Motor driving


Exit : Step Motor driving
Fuser and Fuser relase One way gear are used.
1 BLDC Motor counterclockwise rotation(ccw) 2(cw) 3(cw) (Fuser driving)
1 BLDC Motor clockwise rotation(cw) 4(ccw) 5(cw) 6(cw) (Fuser Release driving)
7 Step Motor 8 RDCN Exit (Exit driving)

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-47


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.7.6. Toner Supply Drive

Power Train Toner Cartridge driving


1 DC Motor 2 Gear-M RDCN SUPPLY 3 Gear-M SUPPLY (Toner Cartridge driving)

2-48 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.8. Scanner System

This section describes the printer scanner system parts and functions.

2.8.1. Scanner System Overview

During the scanning process, the surface of a document is exposed to FR module light.

The light reflected from the paper is led through mirrors, a lens, and a slit to a CCD where optical-to-electrical conversion is
performed, converting the optical image data into an electrical (analog) signal.

This analog signal is changed to a digital signal, which then undergoes various corrective processes necessary for image
formation. After that, arithmetic operations are performed on the digital signal, which is then transmitted to the data
writing processor.

In this machine, a reduction-type CCD for color processing is used. CCD is arranged in 3 lines and covered with color
filters (Red, Green, and Blue).

2.8.2. Scanning System Components

The following shows the construction and purpose of the scanning system :

1) DADF glass
The DADF glass is used when a document is read by the Automatic Document Feeder. The light from the WLED is
illuminated on the Document through this glass.
The document is transported on the DADF glass by the DADF operation.
Do not use such solvents, as alcohol when cleaning the surface of the DADF glass, as it is coated so as not to be
scratched by Document.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-49


2. Product Specifications and Description

2) FR(Full Rate)-Module
FR-Module is consists of the White-LED , Light-Guide, mirror-1 etc.
It is driven by the scan motor (HB Step Motor) and moves across the document on the glass

White-LED
This is a light source for scanning the document on the glass. ( There are 4 White-LEDs. (Front 2 EA, Rear 2 EA)

Light-Guide
This is to efficiently transfer the light creating White-LED to the surface of the document . made of the transparent
Plastic Regin.

Mirror-1
This mirror directs the light reflected from the Document to the mirror-2

3) HR(Half Rate)-Module
HR-Module mainly consists of the mirror-2, mirror-3, etc. The reflected light on document is passed from the mirror-1
through the mirrors-2 and -3 to the lens. HR module is driven by the same scan motor as that of the FR module.
The speed and distance are half that of the FR module.

2-50 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

4) Lens
The light reflected from the mirror-3 is focused to the CCD.

5) CCD board
Processes such as signal amplification, signal integration, and A/D conversion are applied on the electrical signal
which was converted by the CCD.

6) Auto Paper Sensor


The size of an original placed on the glass is instantly detected using the Auto Paper Sensor fixed on the Align-frame.

7) Pulley-Driving
The Steel Wire is coiled to this part and rotated by the scan motor. This also transfers the power to move the FR/HR
module.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-51


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.9. Duplex Automatic Document Feeder(DADF)

2.9.1. DADF overview

Symbol Part Function

R1 Simplex and Duplex Regi. Aligns the leading edge of the paper for registration.
roller
R2 DADF forward roller Separates an original from the tray and transfers it to the paper path.
R3 DADF friction pad Prevent the multi-feeding.
R4 DADF pick up roller Picks up an original from the tray.
R5 Original document tray Paper input tray
R6 Exit tray Paper output tray
R7 Exit roller Sends an original to the exit tray and forms the duplex reverse path.
R8 Feed in roller Feeds an original before scanning.
R9 Feed out roller Transfers a scanned original to the exit roller.

2-52 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.9.2. Electrical parts location

Symbol Description Part Code Controller board


S1 PHOTO-INTERRUPTER 0604-001415 PBA-ADF
(Cover)
S2 PHOTO-INTERRUPTER 0604-001393 PBA-ADF
(Regi)
S3 PHOTO-INTERRUPTER 0604-001393 PBA-ADF
(Detect)
S4 PHOTO-INTERRUPTER 0604-001393 PBA-ADF
(Exit Idle)
S5 PHOTO-INTERRUPTER 0604-001393 PBA-ADF
(Paper Length)
S6 PHOTO-INTERRUPTER 0604-001393 PBA-ADF
(Paper Width)
S7 PHOTO-INTERRUPTER 0604-001393 PBA-ADF
(Exit)
S8 BLCD MOTOR 0604-001393 PBA-ADF
S9 CLUTCH-ELECTRIC 0604-001393 PBA-ADF
(Pick Up)
S10 CLUTCH-ELECTRIC 0604-001393 PBA-ADF
(Regi)

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-53


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.9.3. DADF Drive System

DADF consists of one motor and two clutch to transfer the paper.

A BLDC motor drives the system for simplex and duplex job.
The Pick up and Regi clutch controls the driving on/off.
The Cam type gear and solenoid is used for duplex reverse.

2-54 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.9.3.1. DADF Original Drive Assembly

After detecting the paper, one motor controls the drive system totally.

The CLUTCH-ELECTRIC provides the power to pick up the paper.

The CLUTCH cant rotate inversely. The Spring that is included in DADF-GUIDE PICK UP ASSY is connected to
COVER-OPEN. When the CLUTCH does not drive, it makes Stand-by status and fix the stopper operation.

The ADF roller and Pick up Roller is connected by the belt.

The ADF roller is provided with the power while the paper is picked up and transferred to the Registration roller. When the
pick up drive is stopped and Registration roller is driven, the ADF roller become idle.

The normal process is :

When the original is setting up, the detect-sensor is activated, and printing job starts, the motor and pick up clutch work.
Then, the pick-up roller moves down and contacts an original in the tray.

When the Registration sensor detects the paper, the pick up clutch stops.
When the Detect-Sensor detects that the tray is empty, the motor stops and the machine enters stand-by status.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-55


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.9.3.2. DADF Original Registration (Regi) Drive Assembly

The Regi drive uses the CLUTCH-ELECTRIC to drive the Registration Roller and transfer the paper to ROLLER FEED.

The Registration Roller aligns the leading edge of the original. When original is placed in the Nip, the roller is rotated
for alignment.

The CLUTHC-ELETRIC repeats on/off to align each paper.

The GEAR-KNOB and GEAR-REDUCTION uses the BELT to provide the PULLEY connecting ROLLER-EXIT with the
power. This structure makes the user remove the jammed paper easily.

2.9.3.3. DADF Feed Drive Assembly

The ROLLER FEED is driven by the BELT-TIMMING that is connected to Motor.

The ROLLER-FEED and ROLLER-M IDLE SCF make the feeding force by using a spring pressure method.

The Motor transfers the paper through interlocking the Roller-Feed in and the Roller-Feed out. At scan, the Motor is driven
continually to maintain stable paper transfer.

2-56 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.9.3.4. DADF Exit Drive Assembly

The power from the Motor is transferred to GEAR-EXIT and ROLER-EXIT. The paper is transferred to the exit. At
duplex mode, counter rotation occurs.

To keep the pressure of the Exit Roller, the ROLLER-EXIT_IDLE is pressurized by spring. At duplex mode, when it is
rotated inversely, it make the space between rollers to protect the jam.

The space between rollers is adjusted by LINK-EXIT_IDLE and SENSOR-EXIT_IDLE.

2.9.3.5. Original Return Drive

The solenoid works at only duplex mode.

At Duplex Mode, when the motor rotates inversely, the solenoid is on and the GEAR-CAM OUTER and GEAR-EXIT are
driven.

When the GEAR-EXIT rotates, the solenoid drives the GEAR-CAM and it makes the space between the Roller-Exit and
Idle Roller.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-57


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.10. Hardware Configuration

The SCX-8123/8128 Electrical Circuit System consists of the following :

Main Controller (Main board)


OPE Controller
DADF Controller
HVPS board
SMPS board
FDB board

Diagram of the SCX-8123/8128 Series Electrical Circuit

DCF DADF S CANNER OP E


MODEM
FINIS HER MICOM USB HUB
(S iLa b) MICOM MICOM CCD/AFE 7 TFT
S TM8S GL850 US B HOS T
P ORT2
Debug1 UART CCD I/F
SPI

Ch2 TS P
Debug2

LCD I/F
S-
MS OK IP
Flas h LCD
E 2 P ROM SPI SPI UART Re CP
CONT
4MB 32KB 4
Ch0

I2C
I2C
US B US B
I2C I2C HOS T HUB US B HOS T
Ch1

To n er CP U US B HOS T
GL850 P ORT1
Deve
(C4N) US B
GP IO DEV US B DEVICE US B DEVICE
GP IO
CLUTCH
LS U ETHER RGMII P HY 1Gb p s N/W
S OLENOID P WM P WM S ATA NAND DDR
HP VC
S ENS ORS
600Mhz

UART
32-bit

8-bit
S ATA

FAN
S TEP MOT DDR3 NAND
AVR
BLDC MOT 768MB 512MB
DC MOT
24V
5V

0000000

Opt.
0000000

0000000

HVP S LS U 0000000

0000000
320GB FDB S MP S
0000000

2.5

The main controller handles the video controller, engine controller and scan controller.

The main controller receives print data from the host through the network or USB port, and it receives copy data from the
Scan Controller. It takes this information and generates printable video bitmap data. It controls all modules required to
print, that is, LSU, HVPS, FAN, Fuser, etc.

The main controller communicates with the drive system and other devices through UART. It communicates with the toner
cartridge and drum/developer unit through I2C to check their life.

The main controller adopted Dure Core CPU 1GHZ, DDR3 768MB memory, Flash NAND 512MB, 320GB SATA
HDD(Optional) to control the engine driving, video signal processing, interface, etc. successfully.

A MICOM at the main controller controls the fuser lamp on/off and system power according to an optimized energy-saving
algorithm for optimal efficiency.

2-58 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

The OPE controller transfers the key value to the main controller through UART and adjusts the TFG 7LCD brightness.
The soft power switch in the KEY SUB BOARD is used to safely shut down the system power.

The DADF Controller controls some mechanisms required to scan by feeder continuously and communicates with the main
controller to synchronize the scanning timing.

The HVPS board generates high-voltage channels and controls it. The FDB board controls the fuser lamp On/Off. The
SMPS board generates the 5V, 24V for system power.

Circuit Board Locations


The following diagrams show the locations of the printer circuit boards:

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-59


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.10.1. Main Controller

The main controller consists of the main processor(Chorus4N), memory(DDR3 768MB), flash(512MB), 1G Ethernet PHY,
USB2.0 HUB, Micom(Power/Fuser control), Scan/Video/UI/FAX signal interface connection, motor driving IC, Engine
signal interface connection, power interface.

The main processor (Dual Core 1GHz CPU) controls video, engine, UI display and communicates the various devices. The
HDD is connected to the main controller by SATA cable and to the other device (DADF, DCF, Finisher, Modem) by UART.

1) Main Controller Diagram

2-60 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

2) Main Controller Connection Information

Connection
1 SATA POWER 14 FDB 24 DUCT/OPC/FUSER
MOTOR
2 SATA SIGNAL 15 WASTE
25 EXIT
3 CCD 16 FINISHER
27 SCAN
4 OPE INTERFACE 17 DCF
28 TONER
6 USB HOST (OPE) 18 DEVE
29 MSOK
7 FDI 19 SMPS
30 JTAG
8 CPU FAN 20 SIDE
31 ENGINE DEBUG
9 Giga RJ45 21 CASSETTE
32 VIDEO DEBUG
10 USB HOST JACK 22 FUSER
33 FAX JOINT
11 USB DEVICE JACK 23 MAIN MOTOR /
CLUTCH
12 HVPS
13 LSU

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-61


2. Product Specifications and Description

Information
- Part Code : JC9202452A
- Part Name : PBA-MAIN

3) MSOK
MSOK PBA is used to store all system information and consists of serial flash memory, a EEPROM and a X-CRUM.The
flash memory(4MByte), EEPROM(256Kbit) and X-CRUM are used for all system operation(system parameter, device
status, tech information, and service information).

NOTE

When a main board needs to be exchanged, the MSOK PBA should be re-installed to the new main board to retain the system
information.

4) FAX JOINT PBA


The FAX JOINT PBA is used for interfacing between the main board and modem PBA. It uses UART for interface.

Information
- Part Code : JC92-02439A
- Part Name : PBA-FAX JOINT
Connection
1 Main PBA I/F connector
2 Modem Card I/F connector

2-62 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

5) Modem Card (Optional)


The modem card is used to transfer and receive the fax data through a telephone line. This PBA is controlled by the main
board and has two connectors, connectors, one for the telephone line connection and the other for an external phone
connection.

Information
- Fax Kit model name : : CLX-FAX160
- Part Code : JC92-02558A
- PBA Name : PBA-FAX JOINT
Connection
1 Fax JOINT I/F connector
2 TEL Line I/F connector

3 External Phone I/F connector

6) FDI (Optional)
The FDI Module as a option is used to track machine usage such as the number of print or copy pages for some special
users. This module interfaces to the main board.

Information
- Part Code : JC92-01616A
- PBA Name : PBA-SUB FDI
Connection
1 Connector to Main controller

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-63


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.10.2. OPE controller

The MICOM (ST STM8) on OPE board controls the LED, Key, LCD back light. The LCD data and touch screen is
controlled by the C4N SOC on main board.

The MICOM and Main Controller use the UART for communication. The USB HOST PORT2 for USB HUB is on
OPE board.

The LCD DATA R/G/B 28bit and Control signal is transferred by Serializer/Deserializer.

1) OPE controller diagram

2-64 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

2) OPE MAIN PBA

Information
- Part Code : JC9202428A
- Part Name : OPE MAIN
Connection
1 KEY PBA Interface connector
2 MAIN PBA POWER Interface connector
3 LCD DATA Interface connector
4 USB Host Interface connector
5 LCD TSP Interface
6 LCD BACK LIGHT Interface
7 USB Host Port for Memory Stick

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-65


2. Product Specifications and Description

3) 7 TFT LCD, TOUCH SCREEN

Information
- Part Code : JC0700021A
- Part Name : LCD/TSP

4) OPE KEY PBA

Information
- Part Code : JC9202435A
- Part Name : OPE KEY
Connection
1 Interface Connector to OPE Main

2-66 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.10.3. ADF PBA

ADF PBA controls the DADF driving. It uses RENESASs uPD70F3824(48MHz Main Clock, 256KB Flash memory, 24KB
RAM) and interfaces with MAIN PBA through UART communication. It has one Motor Driver IC for motor driving and
controls one BLDC motor, one solenoid, two clutch, ten sensors.

Information
- SEC-CODE : JC92-02446A
- PBA Name : PBA-ADF
Connection
1 Scan Joint PBA
2 Exit Solenoid
3 Length Sensor 1,2,3 / Width Sensor 1,2
4 Exit Sensor
5 Exit Idle Sensor
6 BLDC Motor
7 Cover Open Sensor / Regi. Sensor / Detect Sensor
8 Pick up Clutch / Regi. Clutch / Scan Read Sensor

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-67


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.10.4. SMPS board

SMPS (Switching Mode Power Supply) board supplies electric power to the Main Board and other boards. The voltage
provided includes +5V, and +24V from a 110V/220V power input. It has safety protection modes for over current
and overload.

Specification
General Input/ Output Voltage

1) AC 110V (90V ~ 135V)

2) AC 220V (180V ~ 270V)

3) Input Current: 13.7A (110V) / 6.8A (220V)

4) Output Power: 1500W


- DC 5V : 55W / DC 5VS : 30W / DC 24V : 432W

Information
110V 220V
Part Code JC44-00093A JC44-00100C

Part Name SMPS Type 5 V1 SMPS Type 5 V2

Connection
1 INPUT_AC
2 OUTPUT_24V1/2/3/4/5/6 (to DC POWER PBA)
3 SMPS Enable
4 OUTPUT_5V1/2/3/4/S1/S2 (to DC POWER PBA)

2-68 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

Input / Output connector


- AC Input Connector (CN1)
PIN Assign PIN NO Description
1 AC_L
AC Input
2 AC_N

- AC Input Connector (CN2)


PIN Assign PIN Name Description
1 GND
2 24VOn_Off AC Input
3 GND

- DC Output Connector (CN3)


PIN Assign PIN Name Description
1 +24V1 Power
2 GND 24V Ground
3 +24V2 Power
4 +GND 24V Ground
5 +24V3 Power
6 GND 24V Ground
7 +24V4 Power
8 GND 24V Ground

- DC Output Connector (CN4)


PIN Assign PIN Name Description
1 +5V1 Power
2 GND 5V Ground
3 +5V2 Power
4 GND 5V Ground

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-69


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.10.5. Fuser Drive Board (FDB)

This board supplies the voltage to Fuser AC, Heater, Main board.

Information
110V 220V
SEC CODE JC44-00210A JC44-00211A
PBA NAME FDB V1 FDB V2

Connection
1 Heater I/F
2 Fuser AC
3 FDB I/F
4 Type 5
5 Main S/W
6 Inlet
7 Heater S/W

2-70 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.10.6. HVPS board

HVPS board generates 7 high-voltage channels, Fuser, T2 +/-, SAW, Grid, DEV DC/AC.

Information
- Part Code : JC4400182A
- Part Name : HVPS MONO
Connection
1 Fuser
2 T2 +/-
3 SAW
4 Fan_ozone
5 Dev AC/DC
6 Grid
7 HVPS I/F

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-71


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.10.7. Eraser PBA

Eraser PBA consists of 18 LEDs. Each LED is used for erasing the negative charges on the surface of the drum after printing.

Information
- Part Code : JC92102551A
- Part Name : PBA-ERASER

2.10.8. Fuser PBA

The Fuser PBA includes CRU memory for Fuser Unit Life Cycle counting. It also provides a connection interface for the
position detecting sensor.

Connection
1 Fuser EEPROM, Pressure Sensor I/F
2 Pressure Sensor

Information
- Part Code : JC9202470A
- Part Name : FUSER PBA

2-72 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.10.9. Waste Sensor PBA

The Waste Sensor PBA detects the waste toner level inside the waste toner container.

Information
Part Code : JC9202471A
Part Name : WASTE SENSOR RX

2.10.10. CRUM PBA

The CRUM PBA includes CRU memory for developer unit, drum unit, toner cartridge life cycle counting.

Information
Part Code : JC92-02456A
Part Name : TONER CRUM

2.10.11. Deve CRUM Joint PBA

The Deve Crum Joint PBA is the interface PBA between the imaging unit(drum unit and developer unit) and the machine.

Information
Part Code : JC9202163A
Part Name : DEVE CRUM JOINT

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-73


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.10.12. Toner CRUM Joint PBA

The Toner CRUM Joint PBA is the interface PBA between the toner cartridge and the machine.

Information
Part Code : JC9202164A
Part name : TONER CRUM I/F

2.10.13. Scan Joint PBA

The Scan Joint PBA has one bipolar step motor drive IC for driving the scanner motor. It functions as connection between
WLED, APS Sensor1, APS Sensor2, Cover Open Sensor1, Cover Open Sensor2, Home Position Sensor and Main PBA.
And it functions as the joint PBA for ADF I/F and 24V, 5V power connectors.

Information
- Part Code : JC9202447A
- Part Name : PBA-SCAN JOINT
Connection
1 MAIN PBA
2 ADF PBA
3 WLED CTL PBA
4 Scan Motor
5 APS Sensor1,2
6 Home Position Sensor, Cover Open Sensor
1,2

2-74 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.10.14. CCDM PBA

The function of this board is to convert the reflected light from an original document to electrical signals. It includes the
CCD, ADC, Logic IC, etc. The CCD converts the reflected light from an original document to three-color analog signals;
red, green, blue. ADC converts each analog signal to digital. And for high speed data transmission, the digital data signal is
converted to LVDS format with serialization.

Information
- Part Code : JC92-02458A
- Part Name : PBA-CCDM
Connection
1 MAIN PBA

2.10.15. WLED CTL PBA

The WLED CTL PBA has the LED DRIVER IC for WLED light drive.

Information
- Part Code : JC9202459A
- Part Name : PBA-WLED CTL
Connection
1 Scan Joint PBA
2 WLED AL Front
3 WLED AL Front

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-75


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.10.16. WLED AL FRONT PBA

The WLED AL FRONT consists of two WLED used as scanner light. The scanner unit has two WLED AL FRONT PBAs.

Information
- Part Code : JC9202460A
- Part Name : PBA-WLED AL Front
Connection
1 WLED CTL PBA

2-76 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.11. DCF Unit

DCF (Double Cassette Feeder) is an optional device to store more papers.

1) Front sectional view

1 Cassette 3 Pickup Assembly 8 Feed Roller (Cassette 4)


2 Feed Roller (Cassette 3) 9 Idle Roller (Cassette 4)
3 Idle Roller (Cassette 3) 10 Forward Roller (Cassette 4)
4 Forward Roller (Cassette 3) 11 Retard Roller (Cassette 4)
5 Retard Roller (Cassette 3) 12 Pickup Roller (Cassette 4)
6 Pickup Roller (Cassette 3)
7 Cassette 4 Pickup Assembly

2) Paper path

1 Tray3 paper path


2 Tray4 paper path

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-77


2. Product Specifications and Description

3) Layout of electrical parts

Ref. Description Parts number DC controller PCB


M1 Feed motor JC31-00033B CN5 3 to 6
M2 Tray3 Pick up motor JC31-00149A CN5 9 to 12
M3 Tray4 Pick up motor JC31-00149A CN5 13 to 16
SW1 Tray3 auto size switch JC32-00013A CN9 1 to 4
SW2 Tray4 auto size switch JC32-00013A CN9 5 to 8
S1 Tray3 feed sensor 0604-001381 CN6 7 to 9
S2 Tray3 limit sensor 0604-001393 CN6 4 to 6
S3 Tray3 paper empty sensor 0604-001393 CN6 1 to 3
S4 Tray4 feed sensor 0604-001381 CN6 16 to 18
S5 Tray4 limit sensor 0604-001393 CN6 13 to 15
S6 Tray4 paper empty sensor 0604-001393 CN6 10 to 12
S7 Door open sensor JC39-01696A CN3 1 to 2

2-78 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

4) Sensor and signal

No. Sensor Signal


1 P_Size_DCF1 Tray3 Paper Size analog signal
3 nP_Empty_DCF1_IHCF Tray3 Paper Empty signal
4 Limit_DCF1_IHCF Tray3 Paper Limit signal
5 Feed_DCF1_IHCF Tray3 Feed signal
6 P_Size_DCF2 Tray4 Paper Size analog signal
8 nP_Empty_DCF2 Tray4 Paper Empty signal
9 Limit_DCF2 Tray4 Paper Limit signal
10 Feed_DCF2 Tray4 Feed signal
11 nDoor_open Door open signal

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-79


2. Product Specifications and Description

5) Paper feeding system

No. Name Description


1 Pickup Roller (Cassette 3) This roller transports the paper from the cassette3 or 4.
6 Pickup Roller (Cassette 4)
2 Forward Roller (Cassette 3) This roller transports the paper from the pickup roller to the feed roller.
7 Forward Roller (Cassette 4)
3 Retard Roller (Cassette 3) When two sheets of paper or more are transported from the pickup roller,
8 Retard Roller (Cassette 4) the torque limit load is bigger than the resistance between the sheets. As
the result, retard roller is stopped and the lower paper is not advanced any
further. When the last sheet is transported from the pick up roller, the
retard roller rotates following the feed roller.
4 Feed Roller (Cassette 3) This roller transports the paper from the forward roller to the basic
9 Feed Roller (Cassette 4) machine.

5 Idle Roller (Cassette 3) When the paper is passed at the feed roller, this roller makes paper
10 Idle Roller (Cassette 4) transporting be smooth.

11 nP_Empty_DCF1 This sensor detects the paper in the cassette3 or 4.


14 nP_Empty_DCF2
12 Limit_DCF1_IDCF This sensor detects whether the paper is at pickup position or not.
15 Limit_DCF2_DCF
13 Feed_DCF1_IDCF This sensor detects the leading edge of the paper that is passing on the
16 Feed_DCF2_DCF feed roller.

2-80 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

6) Block Diagram

The DCF board controls all functions for DCF Assy. It consists of CPU, Motor drive IC.

The Micom in the board receives the information from the paper size sensor, empty sensor, feed sensor etc. and
communicates with the copier main board through the UART.

When being received the print job command from the interface connector (CN7) through UART, DCF board drives the feed
motor and pick up motor to pick up a paper.

This board has 2 LEDs. The left LED is for checking 5V power supply and the right LED is checking the micom operation.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-81


2. Product Specifications and Description

7) Plug and jack location list

Connector Connection
Number
P/J601 Download tool I/F(Minicube)
P/J602 Debug I/F
P/J603 Cover open Switch (24V interlock Switch)
P/J604 USB I/F
P/J605 EMPTY/LIFT/FEED(Tray3,4) Sensor
P/J606 FEED / PICKUP3,4 Motor
P/J607 Interface with Main
P/J608 Papersize sensor(Tray3,4)

2-82 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

2.12. Finisher

1) Front Section View

1 Entrance Sensor 9 Front Door Open Sensor


2 Passthru Sensor 10 Stacker Tray STB Sensor
3 Paddle Home Sensor 11 Stacker Tray Home Sensor
4 Media Height Sensor 12 Paper Feed roller
5 Tamper Home_R Sensor 13 Paper Exit roller
6 Tamper Home_F Sensor 14 Jam door
7 Eject Home Sensor 15 Turning Knob
8 Jam Door Open Sensor

2) Paper Path

1 Finisher Main Tray - Staple / Offset


2 Finisher Top Tray None Staple

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-83


2. Product Specifications and Description

3) Layout of electrical parts

Ref. Part Name Function


S1 SENSOR_TOSHIBA TLP1243(C8) Paddle Home Sensor
S2 SENSOR_TOSHIBA TLP1243(C8) Rear Tamper Home Sensor
S3 SENSOR_TOSHIBA TLP1243(C8) Rear Tamper Home Sensor-LET
S4 AS Sensor_KIA0005C Pass- thru Sensor
S5 AS Sensor_KIA0005C Ejector Home Sensor
S6 SENSOR_TOSHIBA TLP1243(C8) Tray STB Sensor
S7 SM5-108N2-80S-C5 Jam Door Open Sensor
S8 SM5-108N2-80S-C5 Front Cover Open Sensor
S9 SENSOR_TOSHIBA TLP1243(C8) Tray Home Sensor
S10 SENSOR_TOSHIBA TLP1243(C8) Front Tamper Home Sensor
S11 SENSOR_TOSHIBA TLP1243(C8) Media Height Sensor
S12 AS Sensor_KIA0005C Entrance Sensor
M1 ASSY:HB MOTOR:S2M19T Paddle Motor
M2 ASSY:HB MOTOR:S2M19T Feed Motor
M3 ASSY:PM MOTOR:S2M12T Stacker Moving Motor
M4 ASSY:PM MOTOR:S2M12T Rear Tamper Motor
M5 ASSY:PM MOTOR:S2M20T SCU Solenoid
M6 AS-MOTOR DC EJECTOR Ejector Motor
M7 AS-MOTOR PM:Z18:HELICAL Front Tamper Motor
M8 AS-MOTOR PM:STAPLER Stapler Cover Solenoid
M9 AS-MOTOR PM:STAPLER Push Holder Solenoid

2-84 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


2. Product Specifications and Description

4) Block Diagram

5) Plug and jack location list

Connector Connection Connector Connection


P/J725 ENGINE Interface P/J701 Push holder solenoid
P/J718 Door and Cover Switch P/J713 Stapler cover solenoid
P/J706 Stapler unit P/J704 Tamper/Ejector motors and sensors
P/J702 Feeder/Paddle motors and sensors P/J714 SCU solenoid
P/J705 Main tray motor and sensors

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 2-85


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.1. Precautions when replacing parts

3.1.1. Precautions when assembling and disassembling

Use only approved Samsung spare parts. Ensure that part number, product name, any voltage, current or temperature
rating are correct. Failure to do so could result in damage to the machine, circuit overload, fire or electric shock.

Do not make any unauthorized changes or additions to the printer, these could cause the printer to malfunction and
create electric shock or fire hazards.

Take care when dismantling the unit to note where each screw goes. There are 19 different screws. Use of the wrong
screw could lead to system failure, short circuit or electric shock.

Do not disassemble the LSU unit. Once it is disassembled dust is admitted to the mirror chamber and will seriously
degrade print quality. There are no serviceable parts inside.

Regularly check the condition of the power cord, plug and socket. Bad contacts could lead to overheating and fire.
Damaged cables could lead to electric shock or unit malfunction.

3.1.2. Precautions when handling PBA

Static electricity can damage a PBA, always used approved anti-static precautions when handling or storing a PBA.

Precautions when moving and storing PBA


1) Please keep PBA in a conductive case, anti-static bag, or wrapped in aluminum foil.

2) Do not store a PBA where it is exposed to direct sunlight.

Precautions when replacing PBA


1) Disconnect power connectors first, before disconnecting other cables.

2) Do not touch any soldered connections, connector terminals or other electronic parts when handling insulated parts.

Precautions when checking PBA


1) Before touching a PBA, please touch other grounded areas of the chassis to discharge any static electrical charge
on the body.

2) Take care not to touch the PBA with your bare hands or metal objects as you could create a short circuit or get an
electric shock. Take extra care when handling PBAs with moving parts fitted such as sensors, motors or lamps as
they may get hot.

3) Take care when fitting, or removing, screws. Look out for hidden screws. Always ensure that the correct screw is
used and always ensure that when toothed washers are removed they are refitted in their original positions.

3-1 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.1.3. Releasing Plastic Latches

Many of the parts are held in place with plastic latches. The latches break easily; release them carefully.

To remove such parts, press the hook end of the latch away from the part to which it is latched.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 3-2


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.2. Replacing the maintenance part

3.2.1. Developer_Drum Unit_Developer Unit

1. Open the front cover. Open the side cover. And remove 2. Remove the Imaging Unit.
the waste toner container.

NOTE

For replacing these parts, refer to the life table below. (R


: Replacement)
100K 200K 300K 400K 500K 600K
Developer R R R R R R
Drum Unit R R R R R R
Developer R R
Unit

3. Unplug the connector.

3-3 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

4. Remove 2 screws from the right side. 7. Separate the Developer Unit[B] from the Drum Unit[A].

5. Remove 3 screws from the left side. 8. Open the developer cover after removing 1 screw.

6. Remove the left cover.

9. Pour the developer on the protection sheet[A]. Remove


the developer on the surface of the developer roller
while you turn the developer roller.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 3-4


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

10. Fill the developer from the refill bag[A]. Close the 12. Open the front cover.
developer cover. And assemble the Imaging Unit.
NOTE

If you turn on the machine after closing the front cover,


toner will be supplied without TC calibration. It may
affect the image quality.

13. If the developer unit window is enable, push the OK


button.

NOTE

When replacing the developer, not a developer unit,


select the Developer (Information > supply Status >
11. The assembly is reverse order of disassembly. Field Replacement Unit > Developer)

14. Close the front cover.

NOTE

1) The TC calibration will start after closing the front


cover.

2) When completing the TC calibration, the motor


operation will stop and the machine will be ready
status.

3-5 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.2.2. Fuser Unit

1. Open the side cover.

2. Remove the cover[A] after removing 3 screws.

3. Unplug the connector. Remove the Fuser Unit.

3.2.3. Transfer roller

1. Open the side cover.

2. Hold and release the both sides of the transfer roller.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 3-6


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.2.4. Ozone Filter

1. Remove 1 screw.

2. Hold and release the Ozone Filter.

3.2.5. Pick Up_Reverse_Forward Roller

1. Open the side cover. Remove the tray1 and tray2. 2. Lift small tap, remove the pick up/ reverse/ forward
roller.

NOTE

When replacing these rollers, it is recommended that


you replace all three rollers at the same time.

3-7 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.2.6. MP Pick Up_Reverse_Forward

1. Open the MP Tray. Remove the cover[A]. 3. Lift small tap, remove the pick up/ reverse/ forward
roller.

2. Remove the cover[B].


NOTE

When replacing these rollers, it is recommended that


you replace all three rollers at the same time.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 3-8


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.2.7. DADF Pick-up roller Assy

1. Open the DADF-open cover. 3. Remove the DADF Pick-up roller Assy after releasing
2 hooks.
2. Remove the spring.

3.2.8. DADF friction pad

1. Open the DADF-open cover. 2. Remove the DADF friction pad.

3-9 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3. Replacing the main SVC part

3.3.1. Left cover

1. Remove the left cover after removing 9 screws.

3.3.2. Rear Cover

1. Remove 10 screws.

2. Remove the rear cover after removing the ozone filter


[A].

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 3-10


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.3. LSU

1. Remove the left cover. (Refer to 3.3.1) 3. Remove the LSU.

2. Remove 2 screws. Unplug the flat cable.

3.3.4. Temperature Sensor

1. Remove the left cover. (Refer to 3.3.1)

2. Remove the temperature sensor after unplugging the


connector.

3-11 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.5. HVPS board

1. Remove the left cover. (Refer to 3.3.1) 4. Unplug all connectors on the HVPS board. Take out the
HVPS board holder.
2. Remove the bracket [A] after removing 2 screws.

3. Remove 1 screw connecting the ground wire. Open the NOTE


harness saddle. If you remove the LSU, you can unplug the connector
easily.

5. Release the HVPS board after removing 1 screw.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 3-12


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.6. OPC Blow-In Fan

1. Remove the Exit cover after removing 1 screw. 3. Remove the OPC Blow-In Fan unplugging the
connector.

2. Remove the LSU after removing the left cover. (Refer


to 3.3.3)

3-13 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.7. OPE Unit

1. Remove the OPE overlay cover. 4. Remove 2 screws from the front.

2. Remove the sticker covering the screw hole. 5. Open the side cover. Remove 2 screws.

6. Remove the cover[B].

3. Remove the cover[A] after removing 2 screws.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 3-14


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

7. Open the DADF unit. Remove 6 screws.

11. Turn the OPE unit. Unplug all connectors connecting


the machine.
8. Remove the cover [C].

12. Unplug all connectors on OPE Main PBA. Remove 4


9. Remove 3 screws. screws. And then remove the OPE Main PBA.

10. Lift up the OPE unit.


CAUTION

Be careful not to damage in flat cables.

13. Remove 7 screws. Lift up the OPE bracket.

3-15 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

15. Remove the OPE key PBA.

14. Remove the LCD.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 3-16


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.8. Main board

1. Remove the rear cover. (Refer to 3.3.2) 3. Remove the main board after removing 9 screws.

2. Unplug all connectors on the main board.

3.3.9. Ozone Suction Fan

1. Remove the rear cover. (Refer to 3.3.2)

2. Unplug the connector. Remove 1 screw. And remove


the fan.

3-17 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.10. SMPS board

1. Remove the rear cover. (Refer to 3.3.2) 3. Unplug all connectors. Remove 4 screws. And remove
the SMPS board.
2. Remove 4 screws. And remove the SMPS cover.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 3-18


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.11. FDB board

1. Remove the rear cover. (Refer to 3.3.2) 3. Unplug all connectors on FDB board. Remove 4
screws. And remove the FDB board.
2. Remove the SMPS cover after removing 4 screws.

3.3.12. Fuser_Exit Drive Unit

1. Remove the rear cover. (Refer to 3.3.2)

2. Unplug 2 connectors. Remove 4 screws. And remove


the Fuser/Exit Drive unit.

3-19 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.13. Main Drive Unit

1. Remove the Imaging Unit. 4. Unplug 2 connectors. Remove 5 screws. And remove
the Main Drive unit.
2. Remove the rear cover. (Refer to 3.3.2)

3. Open the side cover.

3.3.14. Pick-up Drive unit

1. Remove the rear cover. (Refer to 3.3.2)

2. Unplug the connector. Remove 3 screws. And remove


the Pick-up Drive unit.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 3-20


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.15. Toner Duct Drive Unit

1. Remove the rear cover. (Refer to 3.3.2) 3. Unplug 2 connectors. Remove 4 screws. And remove
the Toner Duct Drive unit.
2. Remove 1 screws.

3.3.16. Toner Supply Drive Unit

1. Remove the rear cover. (Refer to 3.3.2)

2. Unplug the connector. Remove 3 screws. And remove


the Toner Supply Drive unit.

3-21 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.17. Toner Duct

1. Remove the toner cartridge and imaging unit. 4. Remove the Toner Duct after removing 2 screws.

2. Remove the rear cover. (Refer to 3.3.2)

3. Remove the Main Drive unit and Toner Drive unit.


(Refer to 3.3.14 and 3.3.17)

3.3.18. Waste Toner Container sensor

1. Open the front cover. Remove the waste toner 3. Unplug the connector. Remove the sensor.
container[A].

2. Remove the inner cover[B] after removing 6 screws.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 3-22


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.19. Auto Size Sensor

1. Remove the tray1 and tray2. 2. Unplug the connector. Remove 2 screws. And then
remove the sensor.

3.3.20. Exit Unit

1. Open the side cover. Unplug the Exit unit connector. 2. Remove the Exit unit after removing 3 screws.

3-23 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.21. Eraser PBA

1. Open the front cover. Remove the waste toner container 4. Unplug the connector.
and imaging unit.

2. Remove 1 screw.

5. Remove the Eraser sensor.

3. Remove the Exit cover after removing 1 screw.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 3-24


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.22. Side Unit

1. Remove the cover [A] after removing 3 screws. 4. Release the left stopper.

2. Unplug the side unit connector. 5. Remove the Side Unit.

3. Release the right stopper.

3-25 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.22.1. Fuser out sensor

1. Remove 2 screws from the both sides. Lift up the 3. Separate the Cover-side exit after removing 3 screws.
Cover-side exit.

4. Unplug the connector. Remove the Fuser out sensor.

2. Remove the Cover-side exit after unplugging the


connector.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 3-26


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.22.2. Temperature sensor and Duplex sensor

1. Remove the Transfer roller Assy. 3. Remove the temperature sensor after unplugging the
connector.

2. Turn up the Guide-TR Upper after removing 1 screw.


4. Remove 1 screw. Turn up the Holder-DUP SNR. And
remove the duplex sensor after unplugging connector.

3-27 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.22.3. MP unit

1. Remove the Harness-Cover Mono[A] after removing 4. Remove 3 screws.


2 screws.

5. Remove 1 screw.
2. Remove the Harness-Cover Lower [B] after removing
2 screws.

6. Remove 2 screws.

3. Remove 1 screws. Stand the stopper.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 3-28


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

7. Remove 4 screws. 10. Unplug the connectors.

8. Lift up the Cover-Side Duplex Lower. 11. Remove the Cover-MP Front.

9. Remove 2 screws while you lift the Cover-Side Guide 12. Release the Linker from the right of the MP tray.
Feed.

3-29 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

13. Remove the MP Unit. 16. Remove the Bush[D] after removing the E-ring.

14. Remove the MP-cover base. 17. Remove the Bracket-Solenoid after removing 1 screw.

15. Remove the gear [C] after removing the E-ring. 18. Release the MP bracket pick-up after removing 4
screws.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 3-30


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

19. Remove the MP solenoid after removing 2 screws.

3-31 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.23. Fuser unit

1. Remove 3 screws. Remove the cover[A]. And remove 3. Remove 5 screws. Separate the Frame-Upper from the
the fuser unit after unplugging the connector. Frame-Lower. Unplug the connector.

2. Remove 2 screws from the both sides. Remove both


side covers. 4. Remove the Fuser-Pressure sensor after unplugging the
connector.

5. Remove the Fuser Output HR after removing 3 screws.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 3-32


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

6. Remove the Lamp bracket after removing 1 screw. 9. Pull the halogen lamp to the direction of arrow.

7. Unplug the thermostat connector. Remove 1 screw. 10. Remove 4 screws from the front and rear of the Frame
And remove the Lamp bracket. lower.

8. Unplug the opposite thermostat connector. 11. Lift and release the Frame lower.

3-33 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

12. Unplug the connector. Remove 1 screw. And remove 15. Release the NC sensor.
the thermistor.

16. Remove the Spring[A], Cam[B], and Gear[C].


13. Remove 5 screws.

17. Remove the opposite spring[A].


14. Lift and release the bracket after releasing 4 hooks.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 3-34


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

18. Take off the yellow tape. Remove 3 screws. 21. Remove 2 screws from the opposite side. Lift up the
heat roller.

19. Remove the gear[G] after removing the C-ring[F].


22. Remove the Spring bracket[I] after removing the E-ring
[H].

20. Remove 2 screws.

23. Remove the Pressure roller.

3-35 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.24. Pick-Up Unit and sensor

1. Remove the Side Unit. (Refer to 3.3.23) 3. Release the sensor after unplugging the connector.
(Empty sensor[A], Level sensor[B])
2. Remove the Pick-up Unit1,2 after removing 2 screws.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 3-36


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.25. Pick-Up sensor

1. Remove the sensor cover after removing 2 screws. 3. Remove the Pick-Up sensor after unplugging connector.

2. Release the sensor holder after removing 1 screw.

3-37 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.26. Feed Unit

1. Remove the Side Unit. (Refer to 3.3.23) 4. Remove the feed sensor after unplugging the connector.

2. Remove the Feed Unit[A] after removing 1 screw.

3. Remove the bracket[B] after removing 3 screws.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 3-38


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.27. Registration(Regi.) Unit

1. Remove the Side Unit. (Refer to 3.3.23) 4. Remove the Regl. sensor after unplugging the
connector.
2. Remove the Regi.unit [A] after removing 2 screws.

3. Remove the bracket[B] after removing 3 screws.

3-39 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.28. DADF Unit

1. Remove the DADF connector cover. 3. Lift up the DADF unit and release it to diagonal
direction.

2. Remove 1 screw. Unplug the connector.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 3-40


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.28.1. DADF Cover

1. Open the Stacker and Cover-Open. Remove 2 screws. 4. Remove the Cover-Deco F.

2. Remove the Cover-Side R by releasing the bottom 5. Remove 2 screw.


hooks.

6. Release the hook from the bottom.


3. Remove 3 screws.

3-41 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

7. Remove the Cover-Side F.

3.3.28.2. DADF Open Cover

1. Remove the DADF cover. (Refer to 3.3.29.1)

2. Release the DADF Open Cover by pushing it to the


direction of arrow.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 3-42


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.28.3. DADF Stacker

1. Remove the DADF cover. (Refer to 3.3.29.1) 2. Release the Stacker by pushing it and its holder in the
opposite direction.

3.3.28.4. DADF Main board

1. Remove the Cover-Side R. (Refer to 3.3.29.1)

2. Unplug all connectors on the board.

3. Remove the DADF main board after removing 2 screws.

3-43 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.28.5. DADF motor_solenoid_clutch

1. Remove the DADF cover. (Refer to 3.3.29.1~3) 5. Lift up and release the DADF Frame Main after
removing 2 screws.
2. Unplug all connectors on the DADF board.

6. Release the harness holder after removing 2 screw.


3. Remove 1 screw.

7. Unplug the connector. Remove 4 screws. And release


4. Remove 2 screws.
the motor.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 3-44


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

8. Release the solenoid after removing 2 screws. 10. Remove the clutch.

9. Remove 2 springs. Remove 2 screws. And release the


bracket.

3-45 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.28.6. DADF Regi_Cover_Detect sensor

1. Release the corresponding sensor after unplugging


connector.

A : Detect Sensor

B : Cover Sensor

C : Registration Sensor

3.3.28.7. DADF Exit Idle sensor

1. Remove the motor bracket. (Refer to 3.3.29.4)

2. Remove the sensor after unplugging the connector.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 3-46


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.28.8. DADF Exit sensor

1. Remove the DADF Frame-Main. (Refer to 3.3.29.4)

2. Remove the sensor after unplugging the connector.

3.3.28.9. DADF Length_Width sensor

1. Remove the DADF Stacker. (Refer to 3.3.29.3) 3. Remove the defective sensor after unplugging the
connector.
2. Release the sensor cover after removing 3 screws.
A, B : Paper Length Sensor

C, D, E : Paper Width Sensor

3-47 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.29. Scanner Unit

3.3.29.1. Scanner joint board

1. Remove the DADF unit. (Refer to 3.3.29) 3. Unplug all connector. Remove 2 screws. And release
the scanner joint board.
2. Remove the Scan-Rear cover after removing 7 screws.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 3-48


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.29.2. Scan glass

1. Open and stand the DADF unit at 90 degree angle.

2. Remove 5 screws.

3. Remove 2 COVER-GLASS and ADF GLASS.

4. Lift up and release the scan glass.

3-49 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.29.3. APS sensor

1. Remove the scan glass. (Refer to 3.3.30.2) 4. Release the APS sensor after remove 2 screws.

2. Remove the align cover after removing 4 screws.

3. Remove 1 screw. Turn over the holder.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 3-50


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.29.4. FR module

1. Remove the scan glass. (Refer to 3.3.30.2) 4. Unplug the harness.

2. Remove 2 screws.

NOTE

Before removing the below screw, mark the current


gradation position to tighten the screw in the same
position.

3. Release the FR module.

3-51 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.29.5. Scanner Assy

1. Remove the DADF unit and OPE unit. (Refer to 3.3.7 4. Remove 2 screws from the right.
and 3.3.29)

2. Unplug all connectors on the main board.

5. Lift up and release the scanner Assy.

3. Remove 3 screws from the left.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 3-52


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.30. Side Cover Open Switch

1. Remove 10 screws. 3. Release the side cover open switch after removing 1
screw.
2. Remove the rear cover after removing the ozone
filter[A].

3-53 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.31. Front Cover Open Switch

1. Remove the COVER FRONT TOP after removing 2 3. Remove the inner cover after removing 7 screws.
screws.

4. Remove the front cover open switch.

2. Remove the COVER FRONT TOP DECO after


removing 2 screws.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 3-54


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.32. Hard Disk Drive (HDD)

3.3.32.1. Installing the HDD

1. Remove 10 screws. Remove the ozone filter[A]. And 4. Remove the Exit-Cover[B] after removing 1 screw.
remove the rear cover.

5. Remove the COVER-EXIT REAR [C] after removing


2. Connect 2 cables to the main board. 5 screws.

3. Remove the screw cover-sheet. 6. Prepare the HDD Assy.

7. Connect the cable. Tighten 4 screws.

3-55 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.32.2. Replacing the HDD

1. Remove the screw cover sheet. 3. Remove the COVER-EXIT REAR [C] after removing
5 screws.

2. Remove the Exit-Cover [B].


4. Remove 4 screws. Unplug the cable. And remove the
HDD Assy.

5. Install the new HDD Assy.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 3-56


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.33. DCF (Double Cassette Feeder)

3.3.33.1. DCF main board

1. Remove the Bracket Rear Cover after removing 6 2. Unplug all connectors. Remove 4 screws. And release
screws. the DCF main board.

3-57 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.33.2. DCF Feed Motor

1. Remove the Bracket Rear Cover after removing 6 3. Remove 3 E-rings and 3 gears. Remove 2 screws. And
screws. release the feed motor.

2. Unplug the connector. Remove 3 screws. And release


the Feed Drive unit.

3.3.33.3. DCF Pick Up Motor

1. Remove the Bracket Rear Cover after removing 6 2. Unplug the pick up motor connector. Remove 2 screws.
screws. And release the DCF pick up motor.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 3-58


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.34. Finisher

3.3.34.1. Finisher Main Motor

1. Remove the rear cover after 3 screws. 3. Remove 2 screws.

4. Remove the jam cover.

2. Remove 2 screws. 5. Remove 5 screws

6. Remove the Top-Tray.

3-59 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

7. Remove the drive gear after removing the E-ring.

NOTE
8. Release the exit roller.
When reassembling the Top-Tray, check that the
suppresser is in right position.

9. Remove the Bottom-Guide after removing 4 screws.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 3-60


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

10. Remove the Main motor after removing 2 screws.

3-61 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


3. Disassembly and Reassembly

3.3.34.2. Finisher Board

1. Remove the rear cover after removing 3 screws. 2. Disconnect all cables on finisher board.

3. Remove the finisher board after removing 4 screws.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 3-62


4. Troubleshooting

4. Troubleshooting

4.1. Control panel

3 4 5
12
1
6

13
9
7
14
10

15
11
8

1 Display screen Shows the current machine status and prompts during an operation. You can set
menus easily using the display screen.
2 Status LED Shows the status of your machine
3 Job Status Shows the jobs currently running, queued jobs, completed jobs, current error
code or secured jobs.
4 Counter Shows the amount of paper used.
5 Eco Turn into Eco mode.
6 Clear Deletes characters in the edit area.
7 Numeric keypad Dials numbers and enters alphanumeric characters. You can also enter the number
value for document copies or other options.
8 Reset Resets the current machines setup.
9 Redial/Pause Redials the recently sent fax number or received caller ID in ready mode, or
inserts a pause(-) into a fax number in edit mode.
10 Log in/Logout Allows user to log in or log out.
11 On Hook Dial When you press this button, you can hear a dial tone. Then enter a fax number.
It is similar to making a call using speaker phone.
12 Power Turn the power on or off. When the blue LED is on, the machine is powered on
and you can use it. If you turn the machine off, press this button for more than
three seconds. Press Yes when the confirmation window appears.
13 Interrupt Stops a job in operation for urgent copying.
14 Stop Stops an operation at any time. The pop-up window appears on the screen
showing the current job that the user can stop or resume.
15 Start Starts a job.

CAUTION

When you use the display screen, use your finger only. The screen may be damaged with a sharpen pen or anything else.

4-1 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

4.1.1. Introducing the display screen and useful buttons

Display screen

NOTE

For more information, refer to the user guide.

The display screen on the control panel allows user-friendly operation of the machine. Once you press the home icon on
the screen, it shows the display screen. The display screen image in this users guide may differ from your machine
depending on its options or models.

Copy : Enters the Copy menu.


Fax : Enters the Fax menu. Fax is activated on the display screen by installing an optional fax kit.
Stored Document : Enters the Stored Document menu.
Shared Folder : Enters the Shared Folder menu.
Scan to Email : Enters the Scan to Email menu.
Scan to Server : Enters the Scan to Server menu.
Scan to PC : Enters the Scan to PC menu.
Scan to Shared Folder : Enters the Scan to Shared Folder menu.
Quick Copy : Enters the Quick Copy menu.
ID Copy : Enters the ID Copy menu.
USB : Enters the USB menu. When a USB memory device is inserted into the USB memory port on your machine,
USB is activated on the display screen.

Scan to USB : Enters the Scan to USB menu. When a USB memory device is inserted into the USB memory port on
your machine, Scan to USB is activated on the display screen

Machine Setup : You can browse current machine settings or change machine values.

Counter button
When you press the Counter button on the control panel, You can see the number of impressions.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-2


4. Troubleshooting

Total Usage : Displays the total number of impressions.


Large Page : Displays the total number of impressions with large size paper.
Send Usage : Displays the number of images sent via email, server, etc.
Fax Send Usage(PSTN) : Displays the number of sent faxes.

Eco button
The eco feature allows you to save print resources and leads you to eco-friendly printing. When you press the Eco
button, the machine turns eco mode on or off. If the eco mode is on, you can see the eco image on some features. Some
options in the features are not available to use in the eco mode. For detailed information about the eco feature, refer to
the Administrators Guide.

Job Status button


When you press the Job Status button, the screen lists the currently running, queued, and completed jobs.

4-3 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

4.2. Understanding the status LED

The color of the status LED indicates the machine's current status.

Status Description
Off The machine is off-line.
The machine is in power saver mode. When data is received, or any button is pressed, it switches
to on-line automatically.
Green On The machine is on-line and can be used.
Blinking Fax The machine is sending or receiving faxes.
Copy The machine is copying documents.
Scan The machine is scanning documents.
Print When the status LED slowly blinks, the machine is receiving data from the computer.
When the status LED blinks rapidly, the machine is printing data.
Red On The imaging unit is at the end of its lifespan. Remove the old imaging unit and install a new one.
The toner cartridge is totally empty. Remove the old toner cartridge and install a new one.
A paper jam has occurred.
The door is open. Close the door.
There is no paper in the tray. Load paper in the tray.
The machine has stopped due to a major error. Check the display message.
The waste toner container is not installed in the machine, or full waste toner container.
Blinking A minor error has occurred and the machine is waiting for the error to be cleared. Check the
display message. When the problem is cleared, the machine resumes its original task.
The toner cartridge, imaging unit, or waste toner container is near the end of its life. Order a
new toner cartridge, imaging unit, or waste toner container. You can temporarily improve print
quality by redistributing the toner.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-4


4. Troubleshooting

4.3. Updating Firmware

This chapter includes instructions for updating the printer firmware. You can update the printer firmware by using one
of the following methods :

Update the firmware by using the printer control panel


Update the firmware by using the network.

4.3.1. Updating from the Printer Control Panel

WARNING

Failure to follow these instructions could lead to corruption issues and prevent the proper operation of this printer. Follow
all of the instructions carefully.

1) Download the firmware file from the Global Service Partner Network (GSPN) website.

2) Unzip the firmware file to a folder on your PC.

3) Copy the firmware file (*.hds) to a USB flash drive.

NOTE

The firmware files may be up to 500MB in size. USB flash drive size must be a minimum of 2 GB.

4) Press the button on control panel in this order. (Others > Application Management > Application > Install)

5) Plug the USB flash drive into the USB port. Install button will be activated on the Application tab. Press the Install
button.

4-5 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

6) The installation window will list the files on the USB drive. Touch the name of the firmware file to select it.

7) Press the OK button after marking the check box.

8) Once the installation is complete, OK button will be activated. Press OK button.

9) After completing the update, you can find the updated versions at [Machine Setup] > [Machine Details] > [Software
Versions].

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-6


4. Troubleshooting

4.3.2. Updating from the Network

WARNING

Failure to follow these instructions could lead to corruption issues and prevent the proper operation of this
printer. Follow all of the instructions carefully.

Perform the following procedure to update the printer firmware from the network.

1) Go to the SyncThruWeb Service (SWS) main home page. Click [Login] to access as default administrator as shown
below.

NOTE

Login using the Administrator ID and Password established during initial machine setup.

2) Click [Maintenance] on the top menu. And then click [Firmware Upgrade].

4-7 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

3) Click [Upgrade Wizard].

4) Click [Browse]. Choose installation file by browsing file system. And click [Next].

5) The uploading step will start. After this step, next step will be started automatically.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-8


4. Troubleshooting

6) The firmware update will start.

7) Once the installation is complete, the machine power-off and power-on automatically.

4-9 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

4.4. Service Mode (Tech Mode)

4.4.1. Entering/Exiting Service Mode

To enter the service mode, press 1,2,3 number keys simultaneously. When the password dialog box appears, enter 1934
and press the OK button.

To exit the service mode, press the Exit Service button at the right upper corner of the display.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-10


4. Troubleshooting

4.4.2. Service Mode Menu Tree

a) Information Tab
Level 1 Level 2 Level 3 Level 4 Page
Machine Serial Number
Network IP Address
General Page 415
Total Printed Impressions
Machine Installed Date & Time
Customer Replacement Unit Toner Page 415
OPC Unit
Developer Unit
Waste Toner Container
Supply Status Finisher
Field Replacement Unit Page 416
Fuser
Roller
Filter
DADF Roller
Software
Page 416
Version
Information
Power On Hours
Service Hours Low Power Hours Page 416
Power Save(Sleep) Hours
Fault Log Page 416
Supplies Information
Fax Protocol Dump List
Maintenance
Job Duty
Print Reports Page 417
TRC Control History
Usage Counter Report
Error Information Report
Diagnostics Page Report
RTF Format
Export Reports XML Format Page 417
PDF Format

4-11 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

b) Maintenance Counts Tab


Level 1 Level 2 Level 3 Level 4 Page
Fault Counts Page 418
Pick-up Jam
Feed Jam
Print Jam
Duplex Jam
Exit Jam
Feed Jam
Jam Count Regi Jam Page 418
Scan Jam
Scan Jam Exit Jam
Duplex Regi Jam
Maintenance
Counts Duplex Scan Jam
Duplex Exit Jam
Toner Cartridge
OPC Unit
Developer Unit
Part
Replacement Fuser Page 418
Count
Roller
Ozone Filter
DADF Roller
Finisher
Page 420
Handling Count

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-12


4. Troubleshooting

c) Diagnostics Tab
Level 1 Level 2 Level 3 Level 4 Page
Engine NVM Initialization Page 421
Engine
Engine NVM Read/Write Page 421
Diagnostics
Engine Test Routines Page 423
Fax NVM Read/Write Page 426
Fax Diagnostics
Fax Test Routines Page 427
Shade and Print Report
Shading Test Page 428
Print Last Shade Report
Scanner
Diagnostics Scanner/DADF NVM Read/Write Page 428

Scanner/DADF Test Routines Page 429


Automatic Adjustment Page 430
Diagnostics
Magnification Page 431
Print Adjustment
Image Position Page 431
Print Test Patterns
Adjustment Copy Adjustment Image Position Page 432
Automatic Adjustment Page 433
Scan Area Adjustment
Manual Adjustment Page 434
Automatic Adjustment Page 435
DADF Adjustment
Manual Adjustment Page 436
ACS ACS Level Adjustment Page 437
Print Test
Skew Pattern
Patterns

4-13 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

d) Service Functions
Level 1 Level 2 Level 3 Level 4 Page
Main Memory
Page 438
Clear
Device Configuration Data Clear
Temporary & Spool Data Clear
Hard Disk
User Saved Data & Log Clear Page 438
Maintenance
All Saved Data Clear
Hard Disk Check

Count Setting 1 Count Up


Page 438
of Large Pages 2 Count Up
Toner Save Off/5/10/15/20/25/30 % Page 438
Debug Log Off / Job Status / Details Page 439
Service
Capture Log Page 439
Functions
System SYS
Page 440
Recovery ALL
Process Speed
T1 Control Paper for Driver
T1 PWM
TR Control
Paper Group Page 443
Mode
Paper Side
T2 Control
Paper Direction
T2 PWM
Enhanced
Off/On
Security

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-14


4. Troubleshooting

4.4.3. Information

4.4.3.1. General

Information > General


This menu displays the machines serial number, assigned IP address, total printed impressions, and the machine
installed date.

4.4.3.2. Supply Status

Customer Replacement Unit (CRU)


Information > Supply Status > Customer Replacement Unit
This menu displays the machines customer replacement unit status. Users can select one item in the list to check the
information of the selected unit.

Field Replacement Unit (FRU)


Information > Supply Status > Field Replacement Unit
This menu displays the machines field replacement unit status. Users can select one item in the list to check the
information of the selected unit.

In the CRU and FRU list, there are four columns : items, status, current, max life.

Item : Refer to the table below.


Status : This shows the current status of the selected item.
- OK : The current count is smaller than the default warning value
- Check : The current count is bigger than default warning value
- Off : The current count exceeds the max life.
Count : This shows the current count of the selected item.
Max. life : This shows the max capacity of the selected item.
Users can edit the default warning value within the given threshold.

Selecting some items will enable the reset button to reset the current count to 0 after replacing the unit.

Unit Item Max. Life Default Threshold


Toner Black 25K 10% 1~ 30%
OPC Unit Black 100K 10% 5 ~ 30%
Developer Unit Black 300K 10% 5 ~ 30%
Waste Toner Container Waste Toner Container 100K Near Full NA
Finisher Stapler
Finisher NA Near Empty NA
Cartridge
Fuser Fuser 150K (PM Count) 10% 5% ~ 20%

4-15 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Unit Item Max. Life Default Threshold


P/up Roller MP 200K (PM Count) 10% 5% ~ 20%
P/up Roller Kit-tray1 200K (PM Count) 10% 5% ~ 20%
Roller P/up Roller Kit-tray2 200K (PM Count) 10% 5% ~ 20%
P/up Roller Kit-tray3 200K (PM Count) 10% 5% ~ 20%
P/up Roller Kit-tray4 200K (PM Count) 10% 5% ~ 20%
Filter Ozone Filter 150K (PM Count) 10% 5% ~ 20%
DADF Roller Assembly ADF Roller 200K (PM Count) 10% 5% ~ 20%
Side Unit Transfer Roller Unit 150K (PM Count) 10% 5% ~ 20%

4.4.3.3. Software Version

Information > Software Version


This menu displays all the version of the software installed in the system in detail.

4.4.3.4. Service Hours

Information > Service Hours


This menu displays three items, Power on Hours, Low Power Hours and Power Save Hours.
- Power on Hours : It indicates the hours of system power on since the first booting of the system.
- Low Power Hours : It indicates the hours of system low power on since the first booting of the system.
- Power Save Hours : It indicates the hours of system power save since the first booting of the system.

4.4.3.5. Fault Log

Information > Fault Log


This menu displays faults occurred while the system was operating.
Pressing clear button will clear all the save fault log of the system.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-16


4. Troubleshooting

4.4.3.6. Print Reports

Information > Print Reports


This menu displays reports which that can be printed from the system. The following reports will be available to print.
- Supplies Information
- Fax Protocol Dump List
- Maintenance
- Job Duty
- TRC Control History
- Usage Counter Report
- Error Information Report
- Diagnostics Page Report

4.4.3.7. Export Reports

Information > Export Reports


This menu exports report to usb stick. Configuration, Error Information, Supplies Information, Usage Counter Reports
are exported as the form of selected format.

4-17 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

4.4.4. Maintenance Counts

4.4.4.1. Fault Count

Maintenance Counts > Fault Count


This menu displays the fault Counts of the system. Users can select one fault group and press OK to see detailed fault
descriptions. The detailed fault description window displays engine diagnostic code and descriptions of the fault along
with the number of occurrences.

The following list shows the group of the faults defined for the system.

A1 Motor H1 Input (Trays) System S2 Engine System


A2 Fan H2 Output (Bins) System S3 Scan System
A3 Sensor S4 Fax System
C1 Toner Cartridge Unit M1 Input (Trays) System S5 UI System
C3 Imaging Unit M2 Media Path System S6 Network System
C4 Developer Unit M3 Output (Bins) System S7 HDD System
C6 iTB M4 Auto Document Feeder System U1 Fusing Unit
C7 Fusing unit S1 Video System U2 LSU Unit

4.4.4.2. Jam Count

Maintenance Counts > Jam Count


This menu displays the jam Counts of the system. Users can select one jam group, which indicates the location of jams, and
press OK to see a detailed jam location along with the occurrence of the jam.

The following table shows the jam groups defined for the system :

Level 1 Level 2 Level 3


Jam Bypass
Jam 0 Tray 1
Pick-up Jam Jam 0 Tray 2
Jam 0 Tray 3 (DCF)
Jam 0 Tray 4 (DCF)
Jam Feed 1
Jam Feed 2
Print Jam Jam Feed 3 (DCF)
Feed Jam
Jam Feed 4 (DCF)
Jam Regi
Jam Fuser Out
Jam Duplex 1
Jam Duplex 2
Duplex Jam
Jam Duplex Regi
Jam Duplex Return

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-18


4. Troubleshooting

Level 1 Level 2 Level 3


Jam Exit In (Face Down)
Jam Exit Out (Face Down)
Jam Exit In (Face Up)
Exit Jam
Jam Exit Out (Face Up)
Jam Exit In (Inner)
Jam Exit Out (Inner)
Feed In Jam
Feed Jam Feed Out Jam
Feed Idle Jam
Regi In Jam
Regi Jam Regi Out Jam
Regi Idle Jam
Scan In Jam
Scan Jam Scan Out Jam
Scan Idle Jam
Exit In Jam
Scan Jam Exit Jam Exit Out Jam
Exit Idle Jam
Duplex Regi In Jam
Duplex Regi Jam Duplex Regi Out Jam
Duplex Regi Idle Jam
Duplex Scan In Jam
Duplex Scan Jam Duplex Scan Out Jam
Duplex Scan Idle Jam
Duplex Exit In Jam
Duplex Exit Jam Duplex Exit Out Jam
Duplex Exit Idle Jam

4.4.4.3. Part Replacement Count

Maintenance Counts > Part Replacement Count


This menu displays the replacement Counts for the system parts. Users can select one part group and press OK to see the
exact name of the part along with the occurrence of the replacement.

The following table shows groups of the replaceable parts of the system.

4-19 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Unit Item Sensing Method


Toner Cartridge Toner (Black) Auto Sensing
OPC Unit OPC Unit (Black) Auto Sensing
Developer Unit Developer (Black) Auto Sensing
Developer Developer (Black) Auto Sensing
Fuser Fuser Auto Sensing
P/up Roller MP Count Clear
P/up Roller Kit-tray1 Count Clear
Roller P/up Roller Kit-tray2 Count Clear
P/up Roller Kit-tray3 Count Clear
P/up Roller Kit-tray4 Count Clear
Filter Ozone Filter Count Clear
DADF Roller Assembly ADF Roller Count Clear
Side Transfer Roller Unit Count Clear

4.4.4.4. Finisher Handling Count

Maintenance Counts > Finisher Handling Count


This menu displays the sheet counts delivered to finisher tray and finisher set count. Users can select one item and press
OK to see a count information.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-20


4. Troubleshooting

4.4.5. Diagnostics

4.4.5.1. Engine Diagnostics

Engine NVM Initialization


Diagnostics > Engine Diagnostics > Engine NVM Initialization
This menu initializes all engine NVM value to the default.

NVM Read/Write
Diagnostics > Engine Diagnostics > NVM Read/Write
Purpose To change a configuration value for engine firmware.
Operation When the main NVM Read/Write window displays, users can navigate through the list of codes with
Procedure descriptions and saved values.
Users can also input a code to the text box to find a configuration value directly.
After selecting one value, pressing Edit button will open an interface for user input.
Verification N/A
Specification N/A
Reference N/A

Code NVM Description Meaning Default Max/Min


103-0031 Regi Curl Length Buckle Control : Regi On Curl 0 6 / -3
103-0032 Duplex Regi Curl Length Buckle Control : Duplex Regi On Curl 0 6 / -3
(x1)
103-0033 Double Speed Duplex Regi Curl Length Buckle Control : Duplex Regi On Curl 0 6 / -3
(x2)
109-0000 StandBy Temperature offset Target Temperature during standby mode. 0 5 / -5
109-0010 Run Temperature offset Target Temperature during run mode. 0 5 / -5
109-0050 60 gms Temperature offset Media type offset for fuser roll temperature. 0 5 / -5
109-0060 90 gms Temperature offset Media type offset for fuser roll temperature. 0 5 / -5
109-0070 Bond Temperature offset Media type offset for fuser roll temperature. 0 5 / -5
109-0090 Cardstock Temperature offset Media type offset for fuser roll temperature. 0 5 / -5
109-0100 Envelopes Temperature offset Media type offset for fuser roll temperature. 0 5 / -5
109-0110 Labels Temperature offset Media type offset for fuser roll temperature. 0 5 / -5
109-0130 Thick Temperature Offset Media type offset for fuser roll temperature. 0 5 / -5
109-0131 Recycled Temperature offset Media type offset for fuser roll temperature. 0 5 / -5
109-0132 Special Temperature offset Media type offset for fuser roll temperature. 0 5 / -5

4-21 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Engine Test Routines


Diagnostics > Engine Diagnostics > Engine Test Routines
Purpose To perform test routines for the engine.
Operation Procedure When the main Engine Test Routines window displays, users can navigate through the list of routines
that display along with their descriptions. Users can also directly input an EDC code to the text box to
find a routine. Users can select a maximum of 3 routines at the same time.
After selecting one or multiple routines, pressing the OK button will open the test window that lists
selected routines. Users can start/stop a desired test routine.
Verification N/A
Specification N/A
Reference N/A

Code Displayed Name Meaning


100-0010 Main BLDC Motor Ready Detect if Main BLDC Motor runs at normal speed
100-0044 OPC Motor K Black Opc BLDC Motor is On/Off
100-0049 K OPC Motor Ready Detect if Black OPC BLDC Motor runs at normal speed
100-0074 Opc Fan Run Start/Stop OPc Fan run
100-0075 Opc Fan Ready Detects if Opc Fan1 runs at normal speed.
100-0076 Ozone Suction Fan Run Start/Stop Ozone Suction Fan run
100-0077 Ozone Suction Fan Ready Detects if Ozone Suction Fan runs at normal speed.
100-0120 Exit Motor Forward Fast Exit Motor Forward Fast On/Off
100-0130 Exit Motor Forward Slow Exit Motor Forward Slow On/Off
100-0131 Exit Motor Backward Exit Motor Forward Backward On/Off
100-0132 Exit Motor Backward Slow Exit Motor Forward Backward Slow On/Off
100-0140 Duplex Motor Forward Duplex Motor Forward On/Off
100-0141 Duplex Motor Forward Slow Duplex Motor Forward Slow On/Off
100-0160 Duplex Fan1 Run Start/Stop Duplex Fan1 run
100-0180 Dupelx Fan1 Run Ready Detects if Duplex Fan1 runs at normal speed.
100-0200 T1 Elevating Motor T1 Elevate Motor On/Off
100-0210 T2 Elevating Motor T2 Elevate Motor On/Off (Optional)
100-0220 T3 Elevating Motor T3 Elevate Motor On/Off (Optional)
100-0230 T4 Elevating Motor T4 Elevate Motor On/Off (Optional)
100-0241 Waste Toner Led Waste Toner Led On/Off
100-0250 Waste Toner Full Sensor Detect if the waste toner is full or not.
100-0340 Feed Motor Feed Motor is On/Off
100-0370 Tray1 Pickup Motor Tray1 Motor is On/Off
100-0380 Tray2 Pickup Motor Tray2 Motor is On/Off
100-0390 Tray3 Pickup Motor Tray3 Motor is On/Off
100-0400 Tray4 Pickup Motor Tray4 Motor is On/Off
100-0430 Exit2 Motor Forward Exit2 Motor is On/Off
100-0440 Exit2 Motor Backward Exit2 Motor is On/Off
100-0470 DCF Feed Motor DCF Feed Motor is On/Off

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-22


4. Troubleshooting

Code Displayed Name Meaning


100-0480 Duct Motor Duct Motor On/Off.
100-0481 Duct Motor Sensor Duct Motor Rib Sensing.
101-0000 Bypass Feed Clutch Engages drive to pick up a paper from bypass Tray(MP
Tray).
101-0050 Registration Clutch Engages drive to registartion rolls.
101-0190 Out-Bin Full Sensor Detect when a paper is at Out-Bin Full Sensor
101-0191 Out-Bin2 Full Sensor Detect when a paper is at Out-Bin2 Full Sensor
101-0270 MP Clutch MPClutch On/Off
101-0271 MP Solenoid MP Solenoid On/Off
101-0280 Return Gate Solenoid Return Gate Solenoid On/Off
102-0000 Tray1 Home Position Detect when tray1 is closed.
102-0010 T1 Paper Empty Sensor Detect when paper is in Tray1.
102-0041 T1 Paper Size Read Detects Paper Tray1 size.
102-0050 T1 Stack Height Sensor Detects if paper in tray1 is elevated to the sensor.
102-0070 Tray2 Home Position Detect when tray2 is closed.
102-0080 T2 Paper Empty Sensor Detect when paper is in tray2.
102-0111 T2 Paper Size Read Detects Paper Tray2 size.
102-0120 T2 Stack Height Sensor Detects if paper in tray2 is elevated to the sensor.
102-0140 Tray3 Home Position Detect when tray3 is closed.
102-0150 T3 Paper Empty Sensor Detect when paper is in tray3.
102-0181 T3 Paper Size Read Detects Paper Tray3 size.
102-0190 T3 Stack Height Sensor Detects if paper in tray3 is elevated to the sensor.
102-0210 Tray4 Home Position Detect when tray4 is closed.
102-0220 T4 Paper Empty Sensor Detect when paper is in tray4.
102-0251 T4 Paper Size Read Detects Paper Tray4 size.
102-0260 T4 Stack Height Sensor Detects if paper in tray4 is elevated to the sensor.
102-0280 Bypass Paper Empty Sensor Detects when paper is in Bypass Tray(MP Tray).
102-0290 Feed Sensor Detect when a paper is at Feed sensor.
102-0300 T2 Feed Sensor (or Door Open) Detect when a paper is at T2 Feed sensor. (optional)
102-0320 T3 Feed Sensor (or Door Open) Detect when a paper is at T3 Feed sensor. (optional)
102-0340 T4 Feed Sensor (or Door Open) Detect when a paper is at T4 Feed sensor. (optional)
102-0352 DCF Feed Cover Open Detect DCF Cover is closed
102-0360 Regi. Sensor Detect when a paper is at Regi. sensor.
102-0361 FuserOut Sensor Detect when a paper is at FuserOut sensor.
102-0371 Exit2 Sensor Detect when a paper is at Exit2 sensor.
102-0380 Duplex Jam1 Sensor Detect when a paper is at Duplex Jam1 sensor.
104-0000 Waste Install Sensor Detect if Waste is installed.
109-0030 Fuser Motor Forward Fuser Motor Forward On/Off
109-0031 Fuser Motor Backward Fuser Motor Backward On/Off
109-0034 Fuser Motor Ready Detect if Fuser Motor runs at each speed
109-0140 Fuser Gap Home Sensor Detect if the fuser press is located Home position.

4-23 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Code Displayed Name Meaning


110-0000 LSU Motor1 Run Ready Detects if LSU motor1 runs at normal speed.
110-0060 LSU Motor1 Run LSU Motor1 On/Off
111-0030 Toner Dispense Motor Black Toner Dispense(Supply) Motor On/Off
111-0070 Toner Sensor Black TC sensor in developer tank.
113-0350 Finisher Entrance Sensor Detect when a paper is at Entrance Sensor
113-0360 Finisher Exit Sensor Detect when a paper is at Exit Sensor
113-0370 Finisher Paddle Home Sensor Detect Paddle Home position
113-0380 Finisher Left Tamper Home Sensor Detect Lift Tamper Home position
113-0390 Finisher Right Tamper Home Sensor Detect Right Tamper Home position
113-0400 Finisher Media Height Sensor Detect Main Tray level.
113-0410 Finisher Stapler Door Sensor Detect Stapler Door Cover is closed
113-0420 Finisher Jam Cover Sensor Detect Jam Door Cover is closed
113-0430 Finisher Stapler Home Sensor Detect Stapler Home position
113-0440 Finisher Stapler Low Sensor Detect Stapler level
113-0450 Finisher Stapler Selfpriming Sensor Detect Stapler Selfpriming Sensor
113-0460 Finisher Ejector Home Sensor Detect Ejector Home position
113-0470 Finisher Main Tray Home Sensor Detect Main Tray Home position
113-0480 Finisher Stacker Height sensor Detect Stacker Height sensor
113-0490 Finisher Letter Size Sensor Detect Paper Size
113-0500 Finisher Transport Motor Finisher Transport Motor On/Off
113-0510 Finisher Paddle Motor Finisher Paddle Motor On/Off
113-0520 Finisher Left Tamper Motor Finisher Left Tamper Motor On/Off
113-0530 Finisher Right Tamper Motor Finisher Right Tamper Motor On/Off
113-0540 Finisher Media Height Solenoid Finisher Media Height Solenoid On/Off
113-0550 Finisher Staple Unit Motor Finisher Staple Unit Motor On/Off
113-0560 Finisher Ejector Motor Finisher Ejector Motor On/Off
113-0570 Finisher Main Tray Motor Finisher Main Tray Motor On/Off
113-0580 Finisher SCU Solenoid Finisher SCU Solenoid On/Off
113-0590 Finisher Safety Cover Solenoid Finisher Safety Cover Solenoid On/Off

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-24


4. Troubleshooting

4.4.5.2. Fax Diagnostics

Fax NVM Read/Write


Diagnostics > Fax Diagnostics Fax NVM Read/Write
Purpose To change a configuration value for fax firmware.
Operation Procedure When the main NVM Read/Write window displays, users can navigate through the list of
configuration values that display along with description.
Users can also input a code to the text box to find a configuration value directly.
After selecting one value, pressing Edit button will open an interface for user input.
Verification N/A
Specification N/A
Reference N/A

Code (Line 1) Displayed Name Default


20-200 Pause Dial Time 1
20-210 Dial Pulse M/B ratio 0
20-220 Auto Dial Start Pause Time 1
20-300 Ring On Time 170
20-310 Ring Off Time 560
20-320 Ring Detection Freq 1
20-400 DTMF High-Freq Level 8
20-410 DTMF Low-Freq Level 11
20-420 DTMF Timing 5
20-520 Error Rate 2
20-530 Dial Tone Detect 0
20-540 Loop Current Detect 0
20-550 Busy Signal Detect 0
20-700 Line Monitor Setting 0
20-800 Modem Speed 7
20-810 Fax Transmission Level 12
20-830 Auto Dial Timeout 55
20-999 Fax Line Setting

4-25 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Fax Test Routines


Diagnostics > Fax Diagnostics > Fax Test Routines
Purpose To perform test routines for the fax machine.
Operation Procedure When the main Fax Test Routines window displays, users can navigate through the list of routines that
display along with description. Users can also input a code to the text box to find a routine directly.
After selecting one routine, pressing OK button will open the test window that lists selected routine.
Users can start/stop a desired test routine.
Verification N/A
Specification N/A
Reference N/A

Code (Line 1) Displayed Name Code (Line 1) Displayed Name


20-012 Single Tone 110 Hz 20-044 V.29 9600 bps
20-014 Single Tone 1650 Hz 20-045 V.17 7200 bps
20-015 Single Tone 1850 Hz 20-046 V.17 9600 bps
20-016 Single Tone 2100 Hz 20-047 V.17 12000 bps
20-020 DMTF # Line 20-048 V.17 14400 bps
20-021 DMTF * Line 20-049 V.34 2400 bps
20-022 DMTF 0 Line 20-050 V.34 4800 bps
20-023 DMTF 1 Line 20-051 V.34 7200 bps
20-024 DMTF 2 Line 20-052 V.34 9600 bps
20-025 DMTF 3 Line 20-053 V.34 12000 bps
20-026 DMTF 4 Line 20-054 V.34 14400 bps
20-027 DMTF 5 Line 20-055 V.34 16800 bps
20-028 DMTF 6 Line 20-056 V.34 19200 bps
20-029 DMTF 7 Line 20-057 V.34 21600 bps
20-030 DMTF 8 Line 20-058 V.34 24000 bps
20-031 DMTF 9 Line 20-059 V.34 26400 bps
20-040 V.21 300 bps 20-060 V.34 28800 bps
20-041 V.27ter 2400 bps 20-061 V.34 31200 bps
20-042 V.27ter 4800 bps 20-062 V.34 33600 bps
20-043 V.29 7200 bps

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-26


4. Troubleshooting

4.4.5.3. Scanner Diagnostics

Shading Test
Diagnostics > Scanner Diagnostics > Shading Test
Purpose To check quality of scanned images, especially defect in optical devices, including lens, mirror,
lamp, and etc, are suspected.
Operation Procedure Press "Share and Print report to see if the current shading value is correct.
Mono, red, green, blue gray shading values will be shown on the printed report.
When the previous shading value is needed, press Print Last Shade Report.
Verification N/A
Specification N/A
Reference N/A

Scanner/DADF NVM Read/Write


Diagnostics > Scanner Diagnostics > Scanner/DADF NVM Read/Write
Purpose To read and/or write values in the scanner and DADF memory.
Operation Procedure When the main NVM Read/Write window displays, users can navigate through the list of codes
with descriptions and saved values.
Users can also directly input a code to the text box to find a NVM.
After selecting a code, the Edit button will be enabled only if the code is writable.
If the selected code is writable and the Edit button is enabled, press the button to configure the
desired value for the code.
Verification N/A
Specification N/A
Reference N/A

Code NVM Description Meaning Access


05-0000 Pick up Count Pick up Roller Life Count Read Only
05-0010 Document Duplex Reverse Point Document Duplex Reverse Point Read/Write
05-0020 Document Exit Turn Reverse Point Document Exit Turn Reverse Point Read/Write

4-27 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Scanner/DADF Test Routines


Diagnostics > Scanner Diagnostics > Scanner/DADF Test Routines
Purpose To perform test routines for the scanner and DADF.
Operation Procedure When the main scanner/DADF Test Routines window displays, users can navigate through the list
of routines that display along with description.
Users can also input a code to the text box to find a routine directly.
After selecting one routine, pressing OK button will open the test window that lists selected routine.
Users can start/stop a desired test routine.
Verification N/A
Specification N/A
Reference Table below

Code NVM Description Meaning Access


05-0000 Document Length .1 Sensor Document Length .1 Sensor High/Low
05-0001 Document Length .2 Sensor Document Length .2 Sensor High/Low
Document Width1 Sensor Document Width1 Sensor High/Low
Document Width2 Sensor Document Width2 Sensor High/Low
Document Width3 Sensor Document Width3 Sensor High/Low
05-0020 Document Cover Open Sensor Document Cover Open Sensor High/Low
05-0040 Document Detect Sensor Document Detect Sensor High/Low
05-0060 Document Simplex Registration Sensor Document Simplex Registration Sensor High/Low
05-0070 Document Scan Read Sensor Document Scan Read Sensor High/Low
05-0080 Document Exit Sensor Document Exit Sensor High/Low
05-0210 Document Jig Test Low Speed Simplex Document Jig Test Low Speed Simplex
05-0220 Document Jig Test Low Speed Duplex Document Jig Test Low Speed Duplex
05-0230 Document Jig Test High Speed Simplex Document Jig Test High Speed Simplex
05-0240 Document Jig Test High Speed Duplex Document Jig Test High Speed Duplex
Document Exit IDLE Sensor Document Exit IDLE Sensor High/Low
Document Motor Forward Document Motor Forward Start/Stop
Document Motor Backward Document Motor Backward Start/Stop
06-0000 Scanner Original Size Detecting Sensor 1 Scanner Original Size Detecting Sensor 1 High/Low
06-0001 Scanner Original Size Detecting Sensor 2 Scanner Original Size Detecting Sensor 2 High/Low
06-0010 Scanner Cover Open/Close Sensor 1 Scanner Cover Open/Close Sensor 1 High/Low
06-0011 Scanner Cover Open/Close Sensor 2 Scanner Cover Open/Close Sensor 2 High/Low
06-0020 Scanner Platen Motor Forward Scanner Platen Motor Forward Start/Stop
06-0030 Scanner Platen Motor Backward Scanner Platen Motor Backward Start/Stop
Scanner home Sensor Scanner home Sensor High/Low

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-28


4. Troubleshooting

4.4.5.4. Adjustment

Print Adjustment
Diagnostics > Adjustment > Print Adjustment > Automatic Adjustment
Purpose To correct image position of print-outs automatically.
Operation Procedure 1) Press Paper Supply button and select a tray.
2) Press Paper Size button and select a paper size of the previously selected tray.
3) Press Print button. A test pattern will be printed out.
4) Press Next button. The system ask to locate the test pattern.
5) Locate the front side of Scanner A/S Chart at the scanner glass .

NOTE

ADF cannot be used.

6) Press OK button. Automatic scanning will occur .


7) Locate the back side of Scanner A/S Chart at the scanner glass again and press OK button
once more.
8) The system will automatically calculate the proper value based on scanning result of the
test pattern.
9) The new values are set to the system.
Verification Print out and check if all the position of scale marks (a, b, e, f) in the image are located within the
specified limit.
Specification a, b, e, f : 10 mm, 1.5 mm
Reference Scanner A/S Chart

Scanner A/S Chart

Front Side Back Side

4-29 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Diagnostics > Adjustment > Print Adjustment > Magnification


Purpose To correct magnification of print-outs manually.
Operation Procedure 1) Press Vertical Magnification or Horizontal Magnification
2) Vertical magnification (c,g) : If the current value is smaller than the specification, press
+. Otherwise, press -.
3) Horizontal magnification (d,h) : If the current value is smaller than the specification, press
+. Otherwise, press -.

Examp le Vertical Ho rizo ntal


Cas es Ad jus tment Ad jus tment
or = 398.0 mm +20

or = 402.5 mm -25

or = 275.3 mm +17

or = 278.9 mm -19

Verification Print out and measure if the length of vertical (400 mm) and horizontal line (277 mm) in the print-out
are correct.
Specification c, g : 400 mm, 1.5 mm (A3)
d, h : 277 mm, 1.5 mm (A3)
Reference Scanner A/S Chart

Diagnostics > Adjustment > Print Adjustment > Image Position


Purpose To correct image position of print-outs manually.
Operation Procedure 1) Select a tray required adjustment.
2) Change the adjustment value with arrow button. + value will move to Tail-Edge while
- value will move to Lead-Edge.

Simplex Duplex
Example Simplex Duplex
Leading Leading
Cases Side Edge Side Edge
Edge Edge
= 8.5 mm + 15

= 11.6 mm -16

= 8.0 mm + 20

= 13.0 mm -30

Verification Print out and check if all the position of scale marks (,,,) in the image are located within the specified
limit.
Specification a, b, e, f : 10 mm, 1.5 mm
Reference Scanner A/S Chart

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-30


4. Troubleshooting

Copy Adjustment
Diagnostics > Adjustment > Copy Adjustment > Image Position
Purpose To correct image position of copied images manually.
Operation Procedure 1) Select a tray required adjustment.
2) Change the adjustment value with arrow button. + value will move to Tail-Edge while
- value will move to Lead-Edge.

Simplex Simplex Simplex Simplex


Example
Leading Side Leading Side
Cases
Edge Edge Edge Edge
= 11.5 mm -15

= 8.4 mm -16

= 12.0 mm -20

= 7.0 mm + 30

Verification 1) Copy the Scanner A/S Chart . Scanning must be occur at the scanner glass .
2) Check if all the position of scale marks (a, b, e, f) in the image are located within the
specified limit.
Specification a, b, e, f : 10 mm, 1.5 mm
Reference Scanner A/S Chart

4-31 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Scan Area Adjustment


Diagnostics > Adjustment > Scan Area Adjustment > Automatic Adjustment
Purpose To correct image position and magnification of scanned images automatically.
Operation Procedure 1) Locate the Scanner A/S Chart at the scan glass . Note that Lead Edge arrows need to head
to the left side of scan glass and to be placed face down. Also note that the Scanner A/S
Charts come in two sizes, A4 and Letter . Choose one size to meet your primary size of use.
2) Press OK button. Automatic scanning will occur, and the system will automatically
calculate the proper value based on scanning result of the chart .
3) The new value set to the table.
Verification 1) Scan the Scanner A/S Chart and send it to a PC. Scanning must be occur from the scan glass.
2) To check the image position, compare the position of scale marks (a, b) of the chart to
the copy.
3) To check the magnification, compare the length of line c of the chart to the copy.
Specification a, b: 10, 1.5 mm
c : 190, 1.5 mm
Reference A4 Scanner A/S Chart

A4 S ca n n e r A/ S Ch a rt

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-32


4. Troubleshooting

Diagnostics > Adjustment > Scan Area Adjustment > Manual Adjustment
Purpose To correct image position and magnification of scanned images manually. This function is used when
a result of automatic adjustment does not satisfy the expectation.
Operation Procedure 1) Choose one item from the table. There are three items to choose.
Image Position - Leading Edge
Image Position - Side Edge
Magnification - Vertical Direction
2) Select one item and press the Edit button.
3) Change the adjustment value with arrow button.
4) Image Position (a, b) : If the current value is smaller than the specification, press +.
Otherwise, press -.
5) Magnification (c) : If the current value is smaller than the specification, press -. Otherwise,
press +.
6) Press the OK button to apply the new value to the system.

Example Leading Side Vertical Direction


Cases Edge Edge Adjustment
= 11.0 mm -10

= 9.0 mm + 10

= 191.7 mm + 0.8% (-3.4mm)

= 188.1 mm -0.4% (near + 1.8mm)

NOTE

The value of magnification adjustment needs to be calculated based on A3 size, 420mm ((190mm +
10mm*2)*2) if the used Scanner A/S Chart is A4 size.

Verification 1) Scan the Scanner A/S Chart and send it to a PC. Scanning must be occur from the scan glass.
2) To check the image position, compare the position of scale marks (a, b) of the chart to
the copy.
3) To check the magnification, compare the length of line c of the chart to the copy .
Specification a, b: 10 , 1.5 mm
c : 190 , 1.5 mm
Image Position Unit : mm, Scale : 0.1, Min/Max : -6/+6
Magnification Unit : %, Scale: 0.1(0.42mm), Min/Max: 99/101
Reference A4 Scanner A/S Chart

4-33 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

DADF Adjustment
Diagnostics > Adjustment > DADF Adjustment > Automatic Adjustment
Purpose To correct image position and magnification of scanned images via DADF automatically.
Operation Procedure 1) Locate the Scanner A/S Chart at the DADF. Note that Lead Edge arrows need to head to
feeding direction and to be placed face up. Also note that the Scanner A/S Charts come in
two size, A4 and Letter . Choose one size to meet your primary size of use.
2) Press OK button. Automatic scanning will occur ,and the system will automatically
calculate the proper value based on scanning result of the chart .
3) The new values are set to the table.
Verification 1) Copy the Scanner A/S Chart. Scanning must be occur from the DADF.
2) To check the image position, compare the position of scale marks (a, b) of the chart to
the copy.
3) To check the magnification, compare the length of line c of the chart to the copy.
Specification a, b: 10 1.5 mm
c : 190 1.5 mm
Reference A4 Scanner A/S Chart

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-34


4. Troubleshooting

Diagnostics > Adjustment > DADF Adjustment > Manual Adjustment


Purpose To correct image position and magnification of scanned images via DADF manually. This function is
used when a result of automatic adjustment does not satisfy the expectation.
Operation Procedure 1) Choose one item from the table. There are three items to choose.
Image Position - Simplex Leading Edge
Image Position Simplex Side Edge
Magnification Vertical Direction
2) Select one item and press the Edit button.
3) Change the adjustment value with arrow button.
4) Image Position (Simplex Leading Edge, a) : If the current value is smaller than the
specification, press +. Otherwise, press -.
5) Image Position (Simplex Side Edge, b) : If the current value is smaller than the specification,
press -. Otherwise, press +.
6) Magnification (c) : If the current value is smaller than the specification, press -. Otherwise,
press +.
7) Press the OK button to apply the new value to the system.

Examp le Lead ing S id e Vertical Directio n


Cas es Ed g e Ed g e Ad jus tment
= 11.5 mm -15

= 8.8 mm -12

= 191.3 mm +0.6% (near -2.6mm)

= 188.0 mm -0.5% (near +2.0mm)

NOTE

The value of magnification adjustment needs to be calculated based on A3 size, 420mm ((190mm +
10mm*2)*2) if the used Scanner A/S Chart is A4 size.

Verification 1) Copy the Scanner A/S Chart. Scanning must be occur from the DADF.
2) To check the image position, compare the position of scale marks (,) of the chart to the copy.
3) To check the magnification, compare the length of line of the chart to the copy.
Specification a, b : 10 1.5 mm
c : 190 1.5 mm
Image Position Unit : mm, Scale : 0.1, Min/Max : -6/+6
Magnification Unit : %, Scale : 0.1(0.42mm), Min/Max : 99/101
Reference A4 Scanner A/S Chart

4-35 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

4.4.5.5. ACS (Auto Color Sensing)

Diagnostics > ACS


Purpose To set the color coverage ratio of auto color mode in copy function.
Color Coverage Ratio : The ratio of color contents in the original document.
Operation Procedure Change the level from 1 to 5.
Classifies a document as color, if color coverage of the document is higher than predefined
level.
Level 1 has higher probability of classifying documents to color, while level 5 has lower
probability.
Verification Copy the mono copied original with auto color mode and check if print out is monochrome.
Specification
Level 1 Level 2 Level 3 Level 4 Level 5
Color
0.01% 0.05% 0.1% 0.25% 0.5%
Coverage

Reference N/A

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-36


4. Troubleshooting

4.4.6. Service Functions

4.4.6.1. Main Memory Clear

Service Functions > Main Memory Clear


This function resets the main memory of the system to the factory default setting. It can be used to reset the system to the
initial value when the product is functioning abnormally. All the user configured values return to the default values.

To clear the main memory, users need to select the country of the system locates, and rebooting of the system is required.

4.4.6.2. Hard Disk Maintenance

Service Functions > Hard Disk Maintenance > Device Configuration Data Clear
- This function formats all device configuration data, for example, user profile, address book, and devices settings,
on the hard disk.

Service Functions > Hard Disk Maintenance > Temporary and Spool Data Clear
- This function formats all temporary and spool data saved on the hard disk.
Service Functions > Hard Disk Maintenance > User Saved Data and Log Data Clear
- This function formats all the user data, for example, box data, pending secure jobs, font, form, macro, data related
applications, and job log, on the hard disk.

Service Functions > Hard Disk Maintenance > All Saved Data Clear
- This function formats all the data that can be erased with 3 functions above. The function will NOT format the
hard disk entirely.

Service Functions > Hard Disk Maintenance > Hard Disk Check
- This function checks a bad sector in the hard disk. If a bad sector is found, the system will display an error message
and send an email notification to the system administrator.

4.4.6.3. Count Setting of Large Page

Service Functions > Count Setting of Large Page


This function sets count of large page, such as A3 and ledger size, to 1 count or 2 count of the total count. For example, the
total use of 100 A4 impressions and 100 A3 impressions will become 200 impressions if the configuration is set to 1 Count
Up while the total will be 300 impression if the configuration is set to 2 Count Up.

4-37 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

4.4.6.4. Debug Log

Service Functions > Debug Log


This function sets the system log message level. Users can select three options.
- Off : This option disables the logging option.
- Job Status: This option only enables the logging option of user created jobs.
- Details : This option enables all the logging options of the running tasks of the system. Note that this option might
create a trade-off of performance in certain system operation. Use this option when the system behaves abnormally,
and engineers need to investigate problems.

4.4.6.5. Capture Log

Service Functions > Capture Log


This function copies all the saved log in the system to a UBS memory as a zip file. To use this function, a USB memory
needs to be plugged into the system. Note that the size of system log could reach up to 1GB. If the system log size become
considerably huge, it will take longer time to copy to the plugged memory.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-38


4. Troubleshooting

4.4.6.6. System Recovery

Service Functions > System Recovery


This function repairs or formats the HDD of the system. To use this function, a HDD image need to be saved in a USB
memory, and that USB memory needs to be plugged in the system before the execution.

NOTE

Memory stick file system type : FAT16 or FAT32 not NTFS

Memory stick must contain the following 3 files only.


- unix script files x 2
- HDD image file x1

1) From the system recovery UI, Choose SYS to recover only the system partition of the HDD or ALL to recover all
the partition of the HDD.

2) When the system recovery UI is appeared after reboot, choose HDD Repair to repair any corrupted data in the selected
partition or choose HDD Format to format the data in the selected partition.

a) HDD Format

Hidden Partition : This can format and reinstall the only System Binary in HDD. User data is not deleted.

USB : This can format the HDD using USB stick. All data except the stored in MSOK will be deleted.

Network : This can format the HDD using network. All data except the stored in MSOK will be deleted.
b) HDD Repair : This can restore the internal system by checking the HDD error. This is for HDD recovery itself
and irrelevant to the user data in device.

4-39 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

3) When pushing Next button, the login page for authentication will be displayed. The password will be 1934 as the
factory setting password.

4) When pushing Next button, the following page will be displayed.

In case of selecting USB option :

The Next button is pressed after inserting the USB stick.


The system will check for the required packages in the USB stick. If all the packages are present in the USB
stick then the system will be directed to the confirmation page otherwise an Error page will be displayed with
an appropriate error message.

In case of selecting Network option :

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-40


4. Troubleshooting

This page contains two sections :


- Configure device IP address
a) Device IP: IP address for the device
b) Gateway IP: Gateway IP address for the device
c) Subnet Mask: Network Subnet Mask for the device
- Configure samba settings
a) Server IP : IP address of the server.
b) User ID : user ID of the server to login into the server system
c) Password : password of the server system
d) Shared folder : name of the shared folder on the server, where the packages for the system recovery
are present.
The Next button is pressed after providing the above information.
The system will establish the provided IP to the device and try to connect to the server and check for the available
packages on the server.
If Network is establish and all the packages are present in the shared folder of the server then the system will be
directed to the Confirmation page otherwise an Error page will be displayed with an appropriate error message.

5) When pushing Next button on option selection page, the confirmation page will be displayed.

6) When pushing Next button, progress page will be displayed.

7) When completing HDD Recovery or HDD Repair successfully, reboot the machine.

4-41 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

8) After rebooting, the machine will start the system initialization.

NOTE

If the system initialization is not executed, enter the svc mode and execute Full memory clear.
If not, the machine may not work normally.

9) Execute the firmware update using the one ROM FW file after system initialization. This work is a must for all FW
module level.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-42


4. Troubleshooting

4.4.6.7. TR Control Mode

Service Functions > TR Control Mode


Purpose To correct transfer related problems. This function can be used to change the transfer value to
optimize image quality to a certain type of paper.
Operation Procedure 1) TR Control Mode
Choose the paper group, paper side, and paper direction.
Adjust PWM value based on the problem type.
Blur : Increase PWM value
Poor Transfer : Increase PWM value
Re-transfer : Decrease PWM value
White Spot : Decrease PWM value
OPC Cyclic Ghost : Decrease PWM value

Blu r Po o r Tr a n s fe r Re t r a n s fe r

Wh it e Sp o t OPC Cyc lic Gh o s t

Verification Print out a test job and make sure the transfer problem has resolved.
Specification N/A
Reference N/A

4-43 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

4.5. Error Code and Troubleshooting

Messages appear on the control panel display to indicate the machines status or errors.

NOTE

Some messages may not appear on the display depending on the options or models.

Troubleshooting
Error Code Error Message
Page
A1-1111 Motor Failure: #A1-1111. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists 450
A1-1113 Motor Failure: #A1-1113. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists 450
A1-1211 Motor Failure: #A1-1211. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists 452
A1-1213 Motor Failure: #A1-1213. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists 452
A1-2111 Motor Failure: #A1-2111. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists 454
A1-2113 Motor Failure: #A1-2113. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists 454
A1-5113 Motor Failure: #A1-5113. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists 456
A1-5512 Motor Failure: #A1-5512. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists 456
A1-5513 Motor Failure: #A1-5513. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists 456
A1-5610 Motor Failure: #A1-5610. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists 456
A2-2810 Fan Failure: #A2-2810. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists 457
A2-2811 Fan Failure: #A2-2811. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists 457
A2-2910 Fan Failure: #A2-2910. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists 457
A2-2911 Fan Failure: #A2-2911. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists 457
A3-3111 Sensor Failure: #A3-3111. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists 458
A3-3112 Sensor Failure: #A3-3112. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists 458
A3-3113 Sensor Failure: #A3-3113. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists 458
A3-3114 Sensor Failure: #A3-3114. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists 458
A3-3210 Sensor Failure: #A3-3210. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists 460
A3-3211 Sensor Failure: #A3-3211. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists 460
A3-3212 Sensor Failure: #A3-3212. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists 460
A3-3310 Sensor Failure: #A3-3310. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists 461
A3-3311 Sensor Failure: #A3-3311. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists 461
A3-3312 Sensor Failure: #A3-3312. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists 461
A3-3410 Sensor Failure: #A3-3410. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists 461
A3-3411 Sensor Failure: #A3-3411. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists 461
A3-3412 Sensor Failure: #A3-3412. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists 461
C1-1110 Prepare new toner cartridge 462
C1-1130 Replace with new toner cartridge 463
C1-1140 End of life, Replace with new toner cartridge 463
C1-1311 Toner Cartridge Failure: #C1-1311. Install toner cartridge again 464
C1-1411 Toner cartridge is not installed. Install the cartridge 465
C1-1512 Toner cartridge is not compatible. Check users guide 466

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-44


4. Troubleshooting

Troubleshooting
Error Code Error Message
Page
C3-1110 Prepare new imaging unit 467
C3-1130 Replace with new imaging unit 467
C3-1140 End of life, Replace with new imaging unit 467
C3-1211 Imaging Unit Failure: #C3-1211. Please turn off then on 468
C3-1411 Imaging unit is not installed. Install the unit 469
C3-1422 Imaging uint requires chargers cleaning. Clean the unit. 470
C3-1512 Imaging unit is not compatible. Check users guide 471
C6-1310 Fuser unit is not installed. Install it 472
C7-1110 Waste toner container is almost full. Order new one 473
C7-1130 Waste toner container is full. Replace it 473
C7-1311 Waste toner container is not installed. Install it 474
C9-2110 Replace with new Transfer roller 475
C9-2120 Replace with new Transfer roller 475
C9-2220 TR Failure: #C9-2220. Install transfer roller again 476
H1-1311 Paper jam in Tray 3 477
H1-1312 Paper jam in Tray 3 477
H1-1313 Paper jam in Tray 3 477
H1-1314 Paper jam inside of machine 477
H1-1315 Paper jam in Tray 3 477
H1-1317 Paper jam in Tray 3 477
H1-1318 Paper jam in Tray 3 477
H1-1322 Tray 3 cassette is pulled out. Insert it properly 479

H1-1351 Paper is low in Tray 3. Load paper 480

H1-1352 Paper is empty in Tray 3. Load paper 480


H1-1353 Input System Failure: #H1-1353. Pull Tray 3 out and insert it 481
H1-1411 Paper jam in Tray 4 482
H1-1412 Paper jam in Tray 4 482
H1-1417 Paper jam in Tray 4 482
H1-1418 Paper jam in Tray 4 482
H1-1422 Tray 4 cassette is pulled out. Insert it properly 484
H1-1451 Paper is low in Tray 4. Load paper 485
H1-1452 Paper is empty in Tray 4. Load paper 485

H1-1453 Input System Failure: #H1-1453. Pull Tray 4 out and insert it 486

H1-5323 Tray door is open. Close the door 487


H1-5330 DCF Failure: #H1-5330. Check internal DCF connection 487
H2-6700 Paper jam in front of finisher (Display animation) 489
H2-6701 Paper jam inside of finisher (Display animation) 489
H2-6702 Paper jam inside of finisher (Display animation) 489
H2-6703 Paper jam inside of finisher (Display animation) 489

4-45 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Troubleshooting
Error Code Error Message
Page
H2-6704 Paper jam at exit of finisher (Display animation) 489
H2-6705 Paper jam at exit of finisher (Display animation) 489
H2-6706 Finisher Failure: #H2-6706. Check finisher 490
H2-6707 Finisher Failure: #H2-6707. Check finisher 491
H2-6708 Finisher Failure: #H2-6708. Check finisher 491
H2-6709 Finisher Failure: #H2-6709. Check finisher 491
H2-6710 Finisher Failure: #H2-6710. Check finisher 491
H2-6711 Finisher Failure: #H2-6711. Check finisher 491
H2-6712 Finisher Failure: #H2-6712. Check finisher 491
H2-6713 Finisher Failure: #H2-6713. Check finisher 491
H2-6714 Finisher Failure: #H2-6714. Check finisher 491
H2-6715 Finisher Failure: #H2-6715. Check finisher 491
H2-6716 Finisher Failure: #H2-6716. Check finisher 491
H2-6717 Finisher Failure: #H2-6717. Check finisher 491
H2-6718 Finisher Failure: #H2-6718. Check finisher 491
H2-6719 Finisher Failure: #H2-6719. Check finisher 491
H2-6720 Finisher Failure: #H2-6720. Check finisher 491
H2-6721 Finisher Failure: #H2-6721. Check finisher 491
H2-6722 Finisher Failure: #H2-6722. Check finisher 491
H2-6723 Finisher Failure: #H2-6723. Check finisher 491
H2-6724 Finisher Failure: #H2-6724. Check finisher 491
H2-6725 Finisher Failure: #H2-6725. Check finisher 491
H2-6726 Finisher Stapler door is open. Close it (Display animation) 492
H2-6727 Finisher Jam door is open. Close it (Display animation) 492
H2-6728 Finisher Failure: #H2-6728. Check finisher 493
H2-6729 Finisher Failure: #H2-6729. Check finisher 493
H2-6730 Finisher Failure: #H2-6730. Check finisher 493
H2-6731 Finisher Failure: #H2-6731. Check finisher 493
H2-6732 Staple cartridge is low. Replace it 494

H2-6733 Staple cartridge is empty. Replace it 494

H2-6734 Finisher Failure: #H2-6734. Check finisher 495


H2-6735 Too much paper in finisher stacker. Remove printed paper 496
H2-6736 Finisher Failure: #H2-6736. Check finisher 498
H2-6737 Finisher Failure: #H2-6737. Check finisher 498
H2-6738 Finisher Failure: #H2-6738. Check finisher 498
H2-6739 Finisher Failure: #H2-6739. Check finisher 498
H2-6740 Finisher Failure: #H2-6740. Check finisher 498
H2-6741 Finisher Failure: #H2-6741. Check finisher 498
H2-6742 Finisher Failure: #H2-6742. Check finisher 498

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-46


4. Troubleshooting

Troubleshooting
Error Code Error Message
Page
H2-6743 Finisher Failure: #H2-6743. Check finisher 498
H2-6744 Staple Cartiridge not install. Install it 4100
H2-6A50 Finisher Failure: #H2-6A50. Check finisher 4101
M1-1113 Paper jam in Tray 1 4102
M1-1213 Paper jam in Tray 2 4104
M1-1610 Paper jam in MP Tray 4106
M1-3122 Tray 1 cassette is pulled out. Insert it properly 4108
M1-3222 Tray 2 cassette is pulled out. Insert it properly 4109
M1-4111 Input System Failure: #M1-4111. Pull Tray 1 out and insert it 4110
M1-4211 Input System Failure: #M1-4211. Pull Tray 2 out and insert it 4111
M1-5111 Paper is low in Tray 1. Load paper 4112
M1-5112 Paper is empty in Tray 1. Load paper 4112
M1-5211 Paper is low in Tray 2. Load paper 4113
M1-5212 Paper is empty in Tray 2. Load paper 4113
M1-5612 Paper is empty in MP Tray. Load paper 4114

M2-1121 Paper jam in Tray 1 4102

M2-1124 Paper jam inside of machine 4115


M2-1125 Paper jam inside of machine 4115
M2-1131 Paper jam in Tray 2 4104
M2-1134 Paper jam inside of machine 4116
M2-1135 Paper jam inside of machine 4116
M2-1211 Paper jam inside of machine 4117
M2-1213 Paper jam inside of machine 4117
M2-1214 Paper jam inside of machine 4117
M2-1331 Paper jam inside of machine 4118
M2-1333 Paper jam inside of machine 4118
M2-1334 Paper jam inside of machine 4118
M2-2111 Paper jam inside of machine 4118
M2-2113 Paper jam at the top of duplex path 4118
M2-2114 Paper jam at the top of duplex path 4118

M3-1411 Paper jam in exit area 4119

M3-1413 Paper jam in exit area 4120


M3-1414 Paper jam in exit area 4120
M3-2230 Output tray(face down) is full. Remove printed media 4121
M3-2430 Inner output tray is full. Remove printed media 4121
S1-1113 Video System Failure: #S1-1113. Turn off then on 4122
S1-1114 Video System Failure: #S1-1114. Turn off then on 4123
S1-1313 The clock became initial time. Set a time again 4124
S1-1411 Video System Failure: #S1-1411. Turn off then on 4125

4-47 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Troubleshooting
Error Code Error Message
Page
S1-1413 Video System Failure: #S1-1413. Turn off then on 4125
S12111 Video System Failure: #S1-2111. Turn off then on 4126
S1-2411 HDD System Failure: #S1-2411. Turn off then on 4127
S1-2421 HDD System Failure: #S1-2421. Turn off then on 4127
S1-2422 HDD System Failure: #S1-2422. Turn off then on 4127
S1-2510 MSOK System Failure: #S1-2510. Turn off then on 4128
S1-2511 MSOK System Failure: #S1-2511. Turn off then on 4128
S1-2521 MSOK Failure: #S1-2521. Call for service 4128
S1-4111 Video System Failure: #S1-4111. Turn off then on 4129
S1-4311 Video System Failure: #S1-4311. Turn off then on 4130
S1-5521 FDI device is not installed. Install the device 4131
S2-1211 Engine System Failure: #S2-1211. Turn off then on 4132
S2-2311 Engine System Failure: #S2-2311. Turn off then on 4133
S2-4210 Front door is open. Close it 4134
S2-4410 Right door is open. Close it 4135
S3-3111 Scan System Failure: #S3-3111. Turn off then on 4136
S3-3121 Scanner locked or another problem occurred.(No Switch Case)Scanner is locked 4137
S3-3211 Scan System Failure: #S3-3211. Turn off then on 4138
S3-3213 Scan System Failure: #S3-3213. Turn off then on 4138
S3-3214 Scan System Failure: #S3-3214. Turn off then on 4138
S3-3215 Scan System Failure: #S3-3215. Turn off then on 4138
S3-3216 Scan System Failure: #S3-3216. Turn off then on 4138
S3-3217 Scan System Failure: #S3-3217. Turn off then on 4138
S5-3111 UI System Failure: #S5-3111. Turn off then on 4139
S6-3122 Network cable is disconnected. Check it 4140
S6-3123 This IP address conflicts with that of other system. Check it 4141
S6-3128 802.1x authentication failed. Please Contact the System Administrator 4142
S7-2110 Fuser Failure: #S7-2110. Turn off then on 4143
U1-2113 Fuser Unit Failure: #U1-2113. Turn off then on 4144
U1-2115 Fuser Unit Failure: #U1-2115. Turn off then on 4146
U1-2119 Fuser Unit Failure: #U1-2119. Turn off then on 4146
U1-2132 Fuser Unit Failure: #U1-2132. Turn off then on 4147
U1-2135 Fuser Unit Failure: #U1-2135. Turn off then on 4147
U1-2141 Fuser Unit Failure: #U1-2141. Turn off then on 4149
U1-2142 Fuser Unit Failure: #U1-2142. Turn off then on 4149
U1-2316 Fuser Failure: #U1-2316. Turn off then on 4150

U1-2317 Fuser Failure: #U1-2317. Turn off then on 4150

U1-2335 Fuser Failure: #U1-2335. Turn off then on 4151


U1-2337 Fuser Failure: #U1-2337. Turn off then on 4153

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-48


4. Troubleshooting

Troubleshooting
Error Code Error Message
Page
U1-233A Fuser Failure: #U1-233A. Turn off then on 4151
U1-233D Fuser Failure: #U1-233D. Turn off then on 4153
U2-1111 LSU Failure: #U2-1111. Turn off then on 4155
U2-1112 LSU Failure: #U2-1112. Turn off then on 4155
U2-1113 LSU Failure: #U2-1113. Turn off then on 4155
U2-1114 LSU Failure: #U2-1114. Turn off then on 4155
U3-3113 Original paper jam in front of the scanner 4157
U3-3211 Original paper jam in front of the scanner 4157
U3-3212 Original paper jam in front of the scanner 4157
U3-3213 Original paper jam inside the scanner 4157
U3-3214 Original paper jam inside the scanner 4157
U3-3311 Original paper jam inside the scanner 4160
U3-3312 Original paper jam inside the scanner 4157
U3-3313 Original paper jam inside the scanner 4160
U3-3314 Original paper jam inside the scanner 4157
U3-3411 Original paper jam inside the scanner 4159
U3-3413 Original paper jam inside the scanner 4159
U3-3414 Original paper jam inside the scanner 4159
U3-3711 Original paper jam in the exit area of scanner 4160
U3-3713 Original paper jam in the exit area of scanner 4160
U3-3714 Original paper jam in the exit area of scanner 4160
U3-4210 Top door of scanner is open 4161

4-49 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

4.5.1. Ax-xxxx type error code

Error Code
A11111
A11113

Error message
Motor Failure: #A1-1111. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists.
Motor Failure: #A1-1113. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists.

Symptom
Regi/MP motor does not operate. / Regi/MP motor is operational but registers status as stopped.

Troubleshooting method
1) Turn the machine off then on. If the error persists, turn the machine off again.

2) Open the side cover. Check if there are any foreign substances or paper around Regi./MP unit.
(Refer to 3.3.22. Side unit)

3) Remove the Rear-cover.


(Refer to 3.3.2. Rear cover)

4) Check if the Regi/MP motor connector is connected correctly.

5) If the connection is OK, turn the machine on. Enter the SVC mode. Select the motor test.
(Diagnostics > Engine Diagnostics > Engine Test Routines >1000000)
a) If the motor does not operates,

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-50


4. Troubleshooting

i) Check the signal and power with the DVM.

ii) If the checked result is normal, replace the BLDC motor(JC93-00448A).


iii) If the checked result is abnormal, check the following.
- If 24V power is not generated, replace the SMPS board (JC44-00100A (220V) / JC44-00093A (110V))

- If the control signal is abnormal, replace the Main board(JC9202452A).


b) If the motor is operational, check the Pin Num 8.
i) If the value is abnormal, replace the Main board(JC9202452A).
ii) If the value is normal, replace the harness.

4-51 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
A11211
A11213

Error message
Motor Failure: #A1-1211. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists.
Motor Failure: #A1-1213. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists.

Symptom
Fuser motor does not operate. / Fuser motor is operational but regesters status as stopped.

Troubleshooting method
1) Turn the machine off then on. If the error persists, turn the machine off again.

2) Open the side cover. Check if there are any foreign substances or paper around fuser unit.
(Refer to 3.3.22. Side unit)

3) Remove the rear cover


(Refer to 3.3.2. Rear cover)

4) Check if the fuser motor connector is connected correctly.

5) f the connection is OK, turn the machine on. Enter the SVC mode. Select the motor test.
(Diagnostics > Engine Diagnostics > Engine Test Routines > 1000120)
a) If the motor does not operates,
i) Check the signal and power with the DVM.

ii) If the checked result is normal, replace the BLDC motor(JC93-00448A).

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-52


4. Troubleshooting

iii) If the checked result is abnormal, check the following.


- If 24V power is not generated, replace the SMPS board (JC44-00100A (220V) / JC44-00093A (110V)).

- If the control signal is abnormal, replace the Main board(JC9202452A).


b) If the motor is operational, check the Pin Num 8.
i) If the value is abnormal, replace the Main board(JC9202452A).
ii) If the value is normal, replace the harness.

4-53 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
A12111
A12113

Error message
Motor Failure: #A1-2111. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists.
Motor Failure: #A1-2113. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists.

Symptom
OPC motor does not operate. / OPC motor is operational but registers status as stopped.

Troubleshooting method
1) Turn the machine off then on. If the error persists, turn the machine off again.

2) Open the side cover. Check if there are any foreign substances or paper around drum drive unit.
(Refer to 3.3.22. Side unit)

3) Remove the rear cover


(Refer to 3.3.2. Rear cover)

4) Check if the OPC motor connector is connected correctly.

5) If the connection is OK, turn the machine on. Enter the SVC mode. Select the yellow OPC motor test.
(Diagnostics > Engine Diagnostics > Engine Test Routines > 1000000)
a) If the motor does not operates,

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-54


4. Troubleshooting

i) Check the signal and power with the DVM.

ii) If the checked result is normal, replace the BLDC motor(JC31-00123B).


iii) If the checked result is abnormal, check the following.
- If 24V power is not generated, replace the SMPS board (JC44-00100A (220V) / JC44-00093A (110V)).

- if the control signal is abnormal, replace the Main board(JC9202452A).


b) If the motor is operational, check the Pin Num 8.
i) If the value is abnormal, replace the Main board(JC9202452A).
ii) If the value is normal, replace the harness.

4-55 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
A15113
A15512
A15513
A15610

Error message
Motor Failure: #A1-5113. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists.
Motor Failure: #A1-5512. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists.
Motor Failure: #A1-5513. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists.
Motor Failure: #A1-5610. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists.

Symptom
Toner is not supplied normally.

Troubleshooting method
1) Open the front cover. If the toner pipe is blocked, open it.

2) Turn the machine off then on. If the error persists, check the following steps.

3) Enter the SVC mode. Select the toner supply motor test.
(Diagnostics > Engine Diagnostics > Engine Test Routines > 1110040)

4) If the motor does not operate, measure the motor power with DVM.
- Measure 2points together.

a) If 24V power is supplied, replace the Toner supply motor(JC31-00123B).


b) If 24V power is not supplied, check the SMPS and main moard
i) If 24V power is not generated, replace the SMPS board(JC44-00100A (220V) / JC44-00093A (110V)).

ii) If the control signal is abnormal, replace the Main board(JC9202452A).

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-56


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
A22810
A22811
A22910
A22911

Error message
Fan Failure: #A2-2810. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists.
Fan Failure: #A2-2811. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists.
Fan Failure: #A2-2910. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists.
Fan Failure: #A2-2911. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists.

Symptom
Ozone Fan or OPC In fan fan does not operate.

Troubleshooting method

NOTE

Ozone fan error : A22810 / A22811

OPC In fan error : A22910 / A22911

1) Turn the machine off.

2) Remove the rear cover.


(Refer to 3.3.2. Rear Cover)

3) Check if the corresponding fan connector is connected correctly.

4) If the connection is OK, enter the SVC mode and execute fan test.
(Diagnostics > Engine Dignostics > Engine Test Routines > 1000260, 1090040)

5) If the fan does not operate, measure the fan power. (Red line)
- Measure the Red line

4-57 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

a) If 24V power is generated, replace the defective fan.


b) If 24V power is not generated, check the SMPS and main board.
i) Measure 24V power on the SMPS board. If the SMPS board(JC44-00100A (220V) / JC44-00093A (110V))
is defective, replace it.

ii) If the SMPS board is normal, replace the Main board(JC9202452A).

6) If the fan operation is normal but the error persists,


a) Check the yellow line signal with DVM.

b) Check fan operation as connection or disconnection.


i) If the Lock signal is 0V continually, check the harness.
ii) If the harness is OK, replace the Main board(JC9202452A).
iii) If the signal value is different from the table above, replace the Fan(JC93-00500A).

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-58


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
A33111
A33112
A33113
A33114

Error message
Sensor Failure: #A3-3111. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists.
Sensor Failure: #A3-3112. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists.
Sensor Failure: #A3-3113. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists.
Sensor Failure: #A3-3114. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists.

Symptom
The NC sensor in the fuser unit is defective. / The sensor signal is abnormal due to adefective harness.

Troubleshooting method
1) Enter the SVC mode. Execute the sensor test to check the sensor operation.
(Diagnostics > Engine Diagnostics > Engine Test Routines >)
109-0000 : Fuser Temperature A
109-0010 : Fuser Temperature B

2) Remove and disassemble the fuser unit.


(Refer to 3.2.2. Fuser Unit)
(Refer to 3.3.23. Fuser Unit)

3) Measure the resistance value of the Thermistor (1404-001453). If the measured value is out of 307K~430K
@25, replace the thermistor.

4) If the error persists, replace the Fuser unit (JC91-01049A(220V) / JC9101050A (110V)).

5) If the error persists after replacing fuser unit, replace the Main board(JC9202452A).

4-59 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
A33210
A33211
A33212

Error message
Sensor Failure: #A3-3210. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists.
Sensor Failure: #A3-3211. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists.
Sensor Failure: #A3-3212. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists.

Symptom
Inner temperature sensor is defective.

Troubleshooting method
1) Turn the machine off.

2) Enter SVC mode. Execute sensor test to check the sensor operation.
(Diagnostics > Engine Diagnostics > Engine Test Routines > 109-0012)

3) Open the side cover. Measure the resistance value of the connector at both ends.
(Refer to 3.3.22. Side unit)
- If the values is not in 10K 1% (@ 25 ), replace the Photo sensor (1404-001417).

4) If the sensor is normal, replace the Main board(JC92-02452A).

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-60


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
A33310
A33311
A33312
A33410
A33411
A33412

Error message
Sensor Failure: #A3-3310. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists.
Sensor Failure: #A3-3311. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists.
Sensor Failure: #A3-3312. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists.
Sensor Failure: #A3-3410. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists.
Sensor Failure: #A3-3411. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists.
Sensor Failure: #A3-3412. Turn off then on. Call for service if the problem persists.

Symptom
External temperature sensor is defective. / Humidity sensor is defective.

Troubleshooting method
A33310, A33311, A33312 : External temperature sensor

A33410, A33411, A33412 : Humidity sensor

1) Turn the machine off.

2) Enter SVC mode. Execute sensor test to check the sensor operation.
(Diagnostics > Engine Diagnostics > Engine Test Routines > 109-0013)

3) Open the side cover. Measure the resistance value of the connector at both ends.
(Refer to 3.3.22. Side unit)
- If the values is not in 10K 1% (@ 25 ), replace the Photo sensor (JC9300486A).

4) If the sensor is normal, replace the Main board(JC92-02452A).

4-61 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

4.5.2. Cx-xxxx type error code

Error Code
C11110

Error message
Prepare new yellow toner cartridge.

Symptom
Toner remained is 5 ~ 30% of its life.

Troubleshooting method
1) Open the front cover.

2) Remove the toner cartridge(MLT-D709S).


(Toner cartridge with level of Low will be exhausted soon.)

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-62


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
C11130
C11140

Error message
End of life, Replace with new toner cartridge.
End of life, Replace with new toner cartridge.

Symptom
The toner cartridge is at the end of its life.

Troubleshooting method
1) Print the supply information report.

2) Check the life remaining of the toner cartridge.

3) If its life is at the end, turn the machine off and open the front cover.

4) Replace the toner cartridge with new one(MLT-D709S).

4-63 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
C11311

Error message
Imaging Unit Failure: #C3-1312. Install imaging unit again

Symptom
Toner supply is inefficient or abnormal.

Troubleshooting method
1) Turn the machine off. Open the front cover

2) Remove the toner cartridge. Shake the toner cartridge horizontally to distribute the toner evenly inside the cartridge.

3) If the problem persists, check the follows.


a) Check if the Toner Supply Drive Unit(JC9300436A) is defective.
(Refer to 3.3.16. Toner Supply Drive Unit)

b) Check if the Toner Duct Drive Unit(JC9300451A) is defective.


(Refer to 3.3.15. Toner Duct Druve Unit)

4) If the problem persists, replace the Toner cartridge(MLT-D709S).

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-64


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
C11411

Error message
Toner cartridge is not installed. Install it.

Symptom
The toner cartridge is not installed. / The CRUM data is not detected.

Troubleshooting method
1) Open the front cover. Check if the toner cartridge is installed.

2) Remove and reinstall the toner cartridge.

3) If the problem persists, check if the toner cartridge modular jack is contaminated or deformed.

4) Replace the toner cartridge with a new one(MLT-D709S).

4-65 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
C11512

Error message
Toner cartridge is not compatible. Check users guide.

Symptom
Toner cartridge is not compatible.

Troubleshooting method
1) Open the front cover. Remove the toner cartridge and re-install.

2) Print the supply information report. Check the toner cartridge information.

3) If the toner cartridge is not a Samsung genuine, replace it with a new one(MLT-D709S).

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-66


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
C31110
C31130
C31140

Error message
Prepare new imaging unit
Replace with new imaging unit.

Symptom
The Imaging unit has almost reached the end of life.

Troubleshooting method
1) Open the front door and remove the waste toner container.

2) Remove the drum unit.


(Refer to 3.2.1. Developer_Toner cartridge_Drum unit)

3)

4) If its life is at the end, turn the machine off and replace the imaging unit(MLT-R709) with new one.

4-67 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
C31211

Error message
Imaging Unit Failure:#C3-1211. Please turn off then on.

Symptom
Sensor calibration error that detects the toner density for image stabilization control has occurred.

Troubleshooting method
1) Open the front door and remove the waste toner container.

2) Remove the drum unit and reinstall.


(Refer to 3.2.1. Developer_Toner cartridge_Drum unit)

3)

4) If the problem persists, replace the imaging unit(MLT-R709) with new one.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-68


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
C31411

Error message
Imaging unit is not installed. Install the unit.

Symptom
The imaging unit is not installed. / The data of CRUM is not detected.

Troubleshooting method
1) Open the front door and remove the waste toner container.

2) Remove the drum unit and reinstall.


(Refer to 3.2.1. Developer_Toner cartridge_Drum unit)

3) If the problem persists, replace the imaging unit(MLT-R709) with new one.

4-69 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
C31422

Error message
Imaging unit is not installed. Install the unit.

Symptom
The imaging unit need to clean.

Troubleshooting method
1) Open the front door and remove the waste toner container.

2) Remove the drum unit and reinstall.


(Refer to 3.2.1. Developer_Toner cartridge_Drum unit)

3)

4) If the problem persists, clean the drum unit by charger cleaner.

5) If the problem persists, replace the drum unit.(MLT-R709).

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-70


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
C31512

Error message
Imaging unit is not compatible. Check user's guide

Symptom
Imaging unit is not compatible.

Troubleshooting method
1) Open the front door and remove the waste toner container.

2) Remove the drum unit and reinstall.


(Refer to 3.2.1. Developer_Toner cartridge_Drum unit)

3) If the problem persists, replace the imaging unit(MLT-R709) with new one.

4-71 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
C61310

Error message
Fuser unit is not installed. Install it

Symptom
Fuser unit is not detected.

Troubleshooting method
1) Turn the machine off. Re-install the fuser unit. Then turn the machine on.
(Refer to 3.2.2. Fuser unit)

2) If the problemis persists, Print the Supply Information Report and check whether fuser unit life is over.

NOTE

The fuser unit can print up to 150,000 pages.

3) If the problem persists, replace the Fuser unit(110V : JC9101049A, 220V : JC9101050A).

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-72


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
C71110
C71130

Error message
Waste toner container is almost full. Order new one.
Waste toner container is full. Replace it.

Symptom
The life of the waste toner container expires soon or has expired.

Troubleshooting method
1) Open the front cover and remove the waste toner container.

2) Reinstall the waste toner container.

3) If the problem persists, remove the waste toner container.


(Refer to 3.2.1. Developer_Toner cartridge_Drum unit)

4) If the problem persists, replace the waste toner container(MLT-W709).

4-73 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
C71311

Error message
Waste toner container is not installed. Install it.

Symptom
The waste toner container is not installed.

Troubleshooting method
1) Open the front cover and check the waste toner container is installed correctly.

2) Check the waste toner container sensor operates correctly.


(Refer to 3.3.18. Waste toner container sensor)

3) If the problem persists, remove the waste toner container.


(Refer to 3.2.1. Developer_Toner cartridge_Drum unit)

4) If the problem persists, replace the waste toner container(MLT-W709).

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-74


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
C92110
C92120

Error message
Replace with new Transfer roller.

Symptom
Transfer belt is at the end of its life.

Troubleshooting method
1) Open the side-cover.

2) Replace the transfer roller(JC9501520A).


(Refer to 3.2.3. Transfer roller)

4-75 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
C92220

Error message
TR Failure: #C9-2220. Install transfer roller again.

Symptom
The resistance value of the transfer roller is abnormal.

Troubleshooting method
1) Open the side cover.

2) Replace the transfer roller(JC9501520A).


(Refer to 3.2.3. Transfer roller)

3) If the problem persists, replace the HVPS board.


(Refer to 3.3.3. HVPS board)

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-76


4. Troubleshooting

4.5.3. Hx-xxxx type error code

Error Code
H1-1311
H1-1312
H1-1313
H1-1314
H1-1315
H1-1317
H1-1318

Error message
Paper jam in Tray 3.

Symptom
Paper jam has occurred in tray3. (Pick up unit connection is defective. / Pickup rollers are defective. / Feed sensor
is defective.)

Troubleshooting method
1) Open the DCF Take Away-Cover. Remove the jammed paper.

2) Remove tray3. Remove the jammed paper. Close the DCF Take Away-Cover and insert tray3.

3) If this jam error occurs frequently, check the rollers below.


a) Remove the tray3 and tray4.
b) Check if the pick up/ reverse/ forward rollers are assembled correctly.

c) If the pick up/ reverse/ forward rollers are worn out or contaminated, replace the defective roller(JC93-00540A).

4) If pick up/ reverse/ forward rollers have no problem, check the following.
a) Remove the DCF pick up unit1. Check if the feed sensor cable is connected correctly.
b) Check if the sensor cable on DCF board is connected correctly.

4-77 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

c) If the connection is OK, replace the feed sensor(0604-001381).


d) Install the DCF pick up unit1.

5) If the problem persists after checking step 3~4, check the following.
a) Remove the DCF pick up unit1. Check if the sensor and actuator are assembled correctly.
b) When pushing the pickup lever, check if the pick up rollers are down.
c) Replace the DCF pick up unit1(JC93-00513A) or defective part.

6) Check the DCF feed motor.


a) Check if the DCF feed motor cable is connected correctly.
b) If the connection is OK, replace the DCF feed drive unit(JC93-00447A).
(Refer to 3.3.33.2 DCF Feed Motor)

7) Check the DCF pick up motor.


a) Check if the DCF pick up motor cable is connected correctly.
b) If the connection is OK, replace the DCF pick up drive unit(JC93-00442A).
(Refer to 3.3.33.3 DCF Pick Up Motor)

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-78


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
H1-1322

Error message
Tray 3 cassette is pulled out. Insert it properly.

Symptom
Tray 3 is pulled out or the auto size sensor connector is not connected or broken.

Troubleshooting method
1) Remove and insert tray3 correctly.

2) If the problem persists, remove tray3 and tray4. Look inside the machine.

3) Check if the auto size sensor cable is connected correctly. Unplug and reconnect it.

4) If the connection is OK, replace the auto size sensor(JC93-00018A).

5) If the problem persists, replace the DCF board(JC92-02453A).


(Refer to 3.3.33.1. DCF Main Board)

4-79 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
H1-1351
H1-1352

Error message
Paper is low in Tray 3. Load paper.
Paper is empty in Tray 3. Load paper.

Symptom
Paper in the tray is less than 10%. / The photo sensor is defective.

Troubleshooting method
1) Remove tray3. Load the paper in the tray3.

2) If paper is loaded but error message has not disappeared, check the following.
a) Remove the DCF pick up unit1.
b) Check if the photo sensor in the DCF pick up unit1 is contaminated. If so, clean it.
c) If the photo sensor(0604-001393) is defective, replace it.
d) If the actuator(JC66-03199A) is defective, replace it.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-80


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
H1-1353

Error message
Input System Failure #H1-1353 : Pull Tray 3 out and insert it.

Symptom
The paper is not fed from tray3.

Troubleshooting method
1) Remove and insert tray3 correctly.

2) Turn the machine off then on.

3) If the problem persists, turn the machine off.

4) Remove the Bracket Rear Cover after removing 6 screws.

5) Check if the connection between the DCF pick up drive and DCF board is correct.

6) If the connection is OK, replace the pick up drive unit(JC93-00442A).


(Refer to 3.3.33.3. DCF Pick Up Motor)

7) If the problem persists, check the following.


a) Remove the DCF pick up unit1.
b) Check if the photo sensor in the DCF pick up unit1 is contaminated, clean it.
c) If the photo sensor(0604-001393) is defective, replace it.

4-81 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
H1-1411
H1-1412
H1-1417
H1-1418

Error message
Paper jam in Tray 4.

Symptom
Paper jam has occurred in tray4. (Pick up unit connection is defective. / Pickup rollers are defective. / Feed sensor
is defective.)

Troubleshooting method
1) Open the DCF Take Away-Cover. Remove the jammed paper.

2) Remove tray4. Remove the jammed paper. Close the DCF Take Away-Cover and insert tray4.

3) If this jam error occurs frequently, check the follows.


a) Remove tray3 and tray4.
b) Check if the pick up/ reverse/ forward rollers are assembled correctly.

c) If the pick up/ reverse/ forward rollers are worn out or contaminated, replace the defective roller(JC93-00540A).

4) If pick up/ reverse/ forward rollers have no problem, check the following.
a) Remove the DCF pick up unit2. Check if the feed sensor cable is connected correctly.
b) Check if the sensor cable on DCF board is connected correctly.
c) If the connection is OK, replace the feed sensor(0604-001381).
d) Install the DCF pick up unit2.

5) If the problem persists after checking step 3~4, check the following.
a) Remove the DCF pick up unit2. Check if the sensor and actuator are assembled correctly.
b) When pushing the pickup lever, check if the pick up rollers are down.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-82


4. Troubleshooting

c) Replace the DCF pick up unit2(JC93-00513A) or defective part.

6) Check the DCF feed motor.


a) Check if the DCF feed motor cable is connected correctly.
b) If the connection is OK, replace the DCF feed drive unit(JC93-00447A).
(Refer to 3.3.33.2 DCF Feed Motor)

7) Check the DCF pick up motor.


a) Check if the DCF pick up motor cable is connected correctly.
b) If the connection is OK, replace the DCF pick up drive unit(JC93-00442A).
(Refer to 3.3.33.3 DCF Pick Up Motor)

4-83 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
H1-1422

Error message
Tray 4 cassette is pulled out. Insert it properly.

Symptom
Tray 4 is pulled out or the auto size sensor connector is not connected or is broken.

Troubleshooting method
1) Remove and insert tray4 correctly.

2) If the problem persists, remove tray3 and tray4. Look inside the machine.

3) Check if the auto size sensor cable is connected correctly. Unplug and reconnect it.

4) If the connection is OK, replace the auto size sensor(JC93-00018A).

5) If the problem persists, replace the DCF board(JC92-02453A).


(Refer to 3.3.33.1. DCF Main Board)

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-84


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
H11451
H11452

Error message
Paper is low in Tray 4. Load paper.
Paper is empty in Tray 4. Load paper.

Symptom
Paper in tray4 is less than 10%. / The photo sensor is defective.

Troubleshooting method
1) Remove the tray4. Load the paper in the tray4.

2) If paper is loaded but error message has not disappeared, check the following.
a) Remove the DCF pick up unit2.
b) Check if the photo sensor in the DCF pick up unit2 is contaminated. If so, clean it.
c) If the photo sensor(0604-001393) is defective, replace it.
d) If the actuator(JC66-03199A) is defective, replace it.

4-85 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
H1-1453

Error message
Input System Failure #H1-1453 : Pull Tray 4 out and insert it.

Symptom
The paper is not fed from tray4.

Troubleshooting method
1) Remove and insert tray4 correctly.

2) Turn the machine off then on.

3) If the problem persists, turn the machine off.

4) Remove the Bracket Rear Cover after removing 6 screws.

5) Check if the connection between the DCF pick up drive and DCF board is correct.

6) If the connection is OK, replace the pick up drive unit(JC93-00442A).


(Refer to 3.3.33.3. DCF Pick Up Motor)

7) If the problem persists, check the following.


a) Remove the DCF pick up unit2.
b) Check if the photo sensor in the DCF pick up unit2 is contaminated. If so, clean it.
c) If the photo sensor(0604-001393) is defective, replace it.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-86


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
H1-5323

Error message
Tray door is open. Close the door

Symptom
DCF Takeaway-Cover is open. / I/L-Switch harness or connector is defective.

Troubleshooting method
1) Open and close the DCF Take away-Cover correctly.

2) If the problem persists, check the following.


a) Check if I/L-Switch(HARNESS-DCF COVER OPEN)(JC3901696A) is not operated. If it is defective,
replace it.

b) If the I/L Switch is OK, replace the DCF board(JC9202453A).


(Refer to 3.3.33.1. DCF Main Board)

4-87 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
H1-5330

Error message
DCF Failure #H1-5330. Check internal DCF connection.

Symptom
A communication error between the optional tray and the main machine has occurred.

Troubleshooting method
1) Lift up and release the DCF unit from the machine.

2) Remove the Bracket Rear Cover after removing 6 screws.

3) Check if the interface connector is connected to the DCF board. If the interface connector(JC3901690A) is
defective, replace it.

4) If the problem persists, replace the DCF board.


(Refer to 3.3.33.1. DCF Main Board)

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-88


4. Troubleshooting

4.5.4. H2-xxxx (Finisher) type error code

Error Code
H26700
H26701
H26702
H26703
H26704
H26705

Error message
Paper jam inside of finisher
Paper jam at exit of finisher

Symptom
Paper failed to pass finisher's paper transportation path within the specified time.

Troubleshooting method
1) Open finisher jam cover, and make sure that the paper is on the paper path. If there is paper, remove paper manually.

2) If the error does not disappear even after removing paper and closing finisher jam door, follow the instructions
below:
a) Does finisher input sensor work well?
i) Make sure finisher input sensor cable is connected well to the sensor connector.
ii) Make sure finisher input sensor cable is connected well to the main board connector.
iii) Replace the finisher input sensor(JC8109686A).
(Refer to 3.3.34.1 Finisher Main Motor)

iv) Replace the finisher main board(JC8109692A).


(Refer to 3.3.34.2. Finisher Board)
b) Check if any debris is present. Please make sure to remove any debris.

4-89 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
H26706

Error message
Finisher Failure: #H2-6706. Check finisher

Symptom
Transport motor doesnt work.

Troubleshooting method
1) Open finisher jam cover to check if there is a paper jam. If there is paper, remove paper manually. Then close
door to do finisher initialization.

2) If transport motor is still not running and the error does not disappear, follow the instructions below:
a) Does finisher transport motor work well?
i) Make sure finisher transport motor cable is connected well to the transport motor connector.
ii) Make sure finisher transport motor cable is connected well to the main board connector.
iii) Replace the finisher transport motor(JC8109677A).
(Refer to 3.3.34.1 Finisher Main Motor)

iv) Replace the finisher main board(JC8109692A).


(Refer to 3.3.34.2. Finisher Board)

b) Does finisher input sensor work well?


i) Make sure finisher input sensor cable is connected well to the sensor connector.
ii) Make sure finisher input sensor cable is connected well to the main board connector.
iii) Replace the finisher input sensor(JC8109686A).
(Refer to 3.3.34.1 Finisher Main Motor)

iv) Replace the finisher main board(JC819692A).


(Refer to 3.3.34.2. Finisher Board)

c) Does finisher motor gear set work well?


i) Make sure gear set can rotate smoothly.
ii) Make sure each gear is not broken.
iii) Replace the gear set(JC81-09592A / J81-09593A / JC81-09595A / JC81-09596A).
d) Check if any debris is present. Please make sure to remove any debris.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-90


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
H26707 ~ H26725

Error message
Finisher Failure: #H2-67xx. Check finisher

Symptom
Component does not move to or leave home position.

Troubleshooting method
1) If there is jammed paper on the paper path, remove paper manually. Open and close finisher stapler door or jam
cover to check if finisher executes initialization process.

2) If component still doesnt go back to home position and error does not disappear, follow the instructions below:
a) Does finisher input sensor work well?
i) Make sure finisher input sensor cable is connected well to the sensor connector.
ii) Make sure finisher input sensor cable is connected well to the main board connector.
iii) Replace the finisher input sensor(JC8109686A).
(Refer to 3.3.34.1 Finisher Main Motor)
iv) Replace the finisher main board(JC8109692A).
(Refer to 3.3.34.2. Finisher Board)
b) Does finisher component motor work well?
i) Make sure finisher component motor cable is connected well to the motor connector.
ii) Make sure finisher component motor cable is connected well to the main board connector.
iii) Replace the finisher component motor(JC8109680A / JC8109681A).
iv) Replace the finisher main board(JC8109692A).
(Refer to 3.3.34.2. Finisher Board)

c) Do finisher component parts work well?


i) Make sure component parts can move or rotate smoothly.
ii) Make sure there is no any mechanical interference to stop moving or rotating.
iii) Make sure the belt is tight on the correct position, if it has the belt.
d) Does finisher component motor gear set work well?
i) Make sure gear set can rotate smoothly.
ii) Make sure each gear is not broken.
iii) Replace the Eject-Sub Assy.
e) Check if any debris existed. Please make sure to remove any debris.

4-91 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
H26726
H26727

Error message
Finisher Stapler door is open. Close it.
Finisher Jam door is open. Close it.

Symptom
Finisher door is not closed.

Troubleshooting method
1) Close door to perform finisher initialization. If error does not disappear, follow the instructions below:
a) Does finisher door cover close well?
i) The finisher door cover can close well.
ii) The finisher door cover can contact and push input sensor switch well.
iii) The finisher input sensor switch can be pushed well.
iv) Replace finisher cover door(JC8109577A) or Switch(JC8109687A).

b) Does finisher input sensor work well?


i) Make sure finisher input sensor cable is connected well to the sensor connector.
ii) Make sure finisher input sensor cable is connected well to the main board connector.
iii) Replace the finisher input sensor(JC8109686A).
(Refer to 3.3.34.1 Finisher Main Motor)

iv) Replace the finisher main board(JC8109692A).


(Refer to 3.3.34.2. Finisher Board)

c) Check if any debris exists. Please make sure to remove any debris.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-92


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
H26728
H26729
H26730
H26731

Error message
Finisher Failure: #H2-67xx. Check finisher.

Symptom
Finisher stapler head does not move to or leave home position.

Troubleshooting method
1) If there is jammed paper on the stapler, removing paper manually. Open and close finisher stapler door or jam
cover to check if finisher executes initialization process.

2) If stapler still doesnt go back to home position and error does not disappear, follow the instructions below :
a) Can finisher stapler cartridge can be pulled out?
i) Rotate stapler gear manually to move stapler head back to home (top) position.
ii) Remove staple completely from stapler cartridge.
iii) Remove staples from inside stapler.
b) Does finisher stapler input sensor work well?
i) Make sure finisher input sensor cable is connected well to the sensor connector.
ii) Make sure finisher input sensor cable is connected well to the main board connector.
iii) Replace the finisher stapler(JC8107376A).
iv) Replace the finisher main board(JC8109692A).
(Refer to 3.3.34.2. Finisher Board)

c) Does finisher stapler motor work well?


i) Make sure finisher stapler motor cable is connected well to the stapler motor connector.
ii) Make sure finisher stapler motor cable is connected well to the main board connector.
iii) Replace the finisher stapler(JC8107376A).
iv) Replace the finisher main board(JC8109692A).
(Refer to 3.3.34.2. Finisher Board)

d) Check if any debris (staple) exists. Please make sure to remove any debris.

4-93 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
H26732
H26733

Error message
Staple cartridge is low. Replace it.
Staple cartridge is empty. Replace it.

Symptom
Finisher stapler cartridge is necessary to refill.

Troubleshooting method
1) Open finisher stapler door to refill cartridge and then close door. Self-Priming will execute automatically if
necessary. If stapler error or warning does not disappear, follow the instructions below :
a) Does finisher stapler cartridge refill box fit well?
i) Make sure stapler refill box fit well into cartridge.
ii) Make sure staples do not jam near stapler head.
b) Does finisher stapler input sensor work well?
i) Make sure finisher input sensor cable is connected well to the sensor connector.
ii) Make sure finisher input sensor cable is connected well to the main board connector.
iii) Replace the finisher stapler(JC8107376A).
iv) Replace the finisher main board(JC8109692A).
(Refer to 3.3.34.2. Finisher Board)

c) Check if any debris (staple) is present. Please make sure to remove any debris.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-94


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
H26734

Error message
Finisher Failure: #H2-6734. Check finisher

Symptom
Finisher stapler cartridge refill failed.

Troubleshooting method
1) Open finisher stapler door to refill cartridge and then close door. Self-Priming will execute automatically if
necessary. If stapler error or warning does not disappear, follow the instructions below :
a) Does finisher stapler cartridge refill box fit well?
i) Make sure stapler refill box fit well into cartridge.
ii) Make sure staples do not jam near stapler head.
b) Does finisher stapler input sensor work well?
i) Make sure finisher input sensor cable is connected well to the sensor connector.
ii) Make sure finisher input sensor cable is connected well to the main board connector.
iii) Replace the finisher stapler(JC8107376A).
iv) Replace the finisher main board(JC8109692A).
(Refer to 3.3.34.2. Finisher Board)

c) Does finisher stapler motor work well?


i) Make sure finisher stapler motor cable is connected well to the stapler motor connector.
ii) Make sure finisher stapler motor cable is connected well to the main board connector.
iii) Replace the finisher stapler(JC8107376A).
iv) Replace the finisher main board(JC8109692A).
(Refer to 3.3.34.2. Finisher Board)

d) Check if any debris (staple) is present. Please make sure to remove any debris.

4-95 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
H26735

Error message
Too much paper in finisher stacker. Remove printed paper.

Symptom
Finisher output tray is full.

Troubleshooting method
1) Remove paper from the finisher main tray. Main tray will move downward and upward to clear stack full warning.

2) If warning does not disappear, follow the instructions below :


a) Does finisher main tray input sensor (Standby & Home sensor) work well?
i) Make sure finisher input sensor cable is connected well to the sensor connector.
ii) Make sure finisher input sensor cable is connected well to the main board connector.
iii) Replace the finisher input sensor(JC8109686A).
(Refer to 3.3.34.1 Finisher Main Motor)

iv) Replace the finisher main board(JC8109692A).


(Refer to 3.3.34.2. Finisher Board)
b) Does finisher main tray motor work well?
i) Make sure finisher main tray motor cable is connected well to the main tray motor connector.
ii) Make sure finisher main tray motor cable is connected well to the main board connector.
iii) Replace the finisher main tray motor(JC8109679A).
(Refer to 3.3.34.1 Finisher Main Motor)

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-96


4. Troubleshooting

iv) Replace the finisher main board(JC8109692A).


(Refer to 3.3.34.2. Finisher Board)
c) Check if any debris (staple) is present. Please make sure to remove any debris.

4-97 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
H26736 ~ H26743

Error message
Finisher Failure: #H2-67xx. Check finisher

Symptom
Main Tray does not move to or leave home position.

Troubleshooting method
1) If there is jammed paper on the Main Tray, removing paper manually. Open and close finisher stapler door or jam
cover to check if finisher executes initialization process.

2) If Main Tray still doesnt go back to home position and error does not disappear, follow the instructions below:
a) Does finisher input sensor (Standby & Home sensor) work well?
i) Make sure finisher input sensor cable is connected well to the sensor connector.
ii) Make sure finisher input sensor cable is connected well to the main board connector.
iii) Replace the finisher input sensor(JC8109686A).
(Refer to 3.3.34.1 Finisher Main Motor)

iv) Replace the finisher main board(JC8109692A).


(Refer to 3.3.34.2. Finisher Board)

b) Does finisher Main Tray motor work well?


i) Make sure finisher Main Tray motor cable is connected well to the motor connector.
ii) Make sure finisher Main Tray motor cable is connected well to the main board connector.
iii) Replace the finisher Main Tray motor(JC8109679A).
(Refer to 3.3.34.1 Finisher Main Motor)

iv) Replace the finisher main board(JC8109692A).


(Refer to 3.3.34.2. Finisher Board)

c) Do finisher Main Tray parts work well?


i) Make sure Main Tray parts can move or rotate smoothly.
ii) Make sure there are no mechanical interference to stop moving or rotating.
iii) Make sure the belt is tight in the correct position, if it has a belt.
d) Does finisher Main Tray motor gear set work well?
i) Make sure gear set can rotate smoothly.
ii) Make sure each gear is not broken.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-98


4. Troubleshooting

iii) Replace the gear set(JC819585A / JC8109586A).

e) Check if any debris is present. Please make sure to remove any debris.

4-99 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
H26744

Error message
Staple Cartridge not install. Install it.

Symptom
Finisher stapler cartridge is not installed into stapler.

Troubleshooting method
1) Open finisher stapler door to put cartridge into stapler and then close door. Self-Priming will be execute
automatically if necessary.

2) If stapler warning does not disappear, follow the instructions below :


a) Does finisher stapler input sensor work well?
i) Make sure finisher input sensor cable is connected well to the sensor connector.
ii) Make sure finisher input sensor cable is connected well to the main board connector.
iii) Replace the finisher stapler cartridge(JC8108653A).

iv) Replace the finisher stapler(JC8107376A).


v) Replace the finisher main board(JC8109692A).
(Refer to 3.3.34.2. Finisher Board)

b) Check if any debris is present. Please make sure to remove any debris.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-100


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
H26A50

Error message
Finisher Failure: #H2-6A50. Check finisher.

Symptom
Communication error with finisher has occurred.

Troubleshooting method
1) Copier power off and power on. If the error does not disappear, follow the instructions below:

2) Does finisher work well?


a) Make sure finisher interface cable is connected with main board.
b) Replace the finisher main board(JC8109692A).
(Refer to 3.3.34.2. Finisher Board)

Error Code
H26A63

Error message
Finisher Failure: #H2-6A63. Check finisher.

Symptom
Finisher stapler cartridge is not installed into stapler or Staples are empty.

Troubleshooting method
1) Replace the finisher stapler(JC8107376A).

4-101 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

4.5.5. Mx-xxxx type error code

Error Code
M11113
M21121

Error message
Paper jam in Tray 1.

Symptom
Paper jam has occurred in tray1.

Troubleshooting method
1) Open the side cover and check if a foreign substance or paper is jammed inside the unit.

2) Remove tray1 and remove the jammed paper.

3) If this jam error occurs frequently, check the rollers of the pickup-roller unit.

a) Check if the pick up/ reverse/ forward rollers are assembled correctly.
b) If the pick up/ reverse/ forward rollers are worn out or contaminated, replace the defective roller(JC9300540A).
(Refer to 3.2.5. Pickup_Reverse_Forward roller)

4) If the problem persists, check the pickup unit and feed sensor.
a) Check if the pickup unit and feed sensor operate correctly.
b) Check if the harness from pickup unit to main board is connected correctly.
c) Check if the connector of the fuide-feed assembly is connected correctly.
d) Check if the harness of pickup unit and feed sensor is disconnected.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-102


4. Troubleshooting

5) If the problem persists, check the pickup unit.


a) Remove the pickup unit and check the connection of the actuator and actuator-sensor.
b) Push the pickup-lever and check if it operates correctly.

6) If the problem persists, replace the pickup drive unit(JC9300422A) or Pickup unit(JC9300540A).
(Refer to 3.3.14. Pick-up Drive unit)

(Refer to 3.3.24. Pick-up Unit and Sensor)

4-103 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
M11213
M21131

Error message
Paper jam in Tray 2.

Symptom
Paper jam has occurred in tray2.

Troubleshooting method
1) Open the side cover and check if a foreign substance or paper is jammed inside the unit.

2) Remove tray2 and remove the jammed paper.

3) If this jam error occurs frequently, check the rollers of the pickup-roller unit.

a) Check if the pick up/ reverse/ forward rollers are assembled correctly.
b) If the pick up/ reverse/ forward rollers are worn out or contaminated, replace the defective roller(JC9300540A).
(Refer to 3.2.5. Pickup_Reverse_Forward roller)

4) If the problem persists, check the pickup unit and feed sensor.
a) Check if the pickup unit and feed sensor operate correctly.
b) Check if the harness from pickup unit to main board is connected correctly.
c) Check if the connector of the fuide-feed assembly is connected correctly.
d) Check if the harness of pickup unit and feed sensor is disconnected.

5) If the problem persists, check the pickup unit.


a) Remove the pickup unit and check the connection of the actuator and actuator-sensor.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-104


4. Troubleshooting

b) Push the pickup-lever and check if it operates correctly.

6) If the problem persists, replace the pickup drive unit(JC9300422A) or Pickup unit(JC9300540A).
(Refer to 3.3.14. Pick-up Drive unit)

(Refer to 3.3.24. Pick-up Unit and Sensor)

4-105 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
M11610

Error message
Paper jam in MP Tray.

Symptom
Paper jam has occurred in MP tray.

Troubleshooting method
1) Open the side cover. Remove the jammed paper from the MP tray.

2) If this jam error occurs frequently, check the rollers of the MP unit.

a) Check if the MP pick up/ reverse/ forward rollers are assembled correctly.
b) If the MP pick up/ reverse/ forward rollers are worn out or contaminated, replace the defective
roller(JC9300540A).
(Refer to 3.2.6. MP Pickup_Reverse_Forward roller)

3) If the problem persists, check if the MP solenoid operates correctly.


a) By Service-mode, Check the operation of solenoid.
(Diagnostics > Engine Diagnostics > Engine Test Routines > 1010271

b) If the MP solenoid is defective, check the connection of MP unit.


c) If the harness has no defects, replace the solenoid(JC3300029B).
If the problem persists, check the main drive unit.
a) Check the harness from Regi/MP drive unit to main board.
b) By service-mode, check if the drive motor and clutch operate correctly.
(Diagnostics > Engine Diagnostics > Engine Test Routines > 1000010)
(Diagnostics > Engine Diagnostics > Engine Test Routines > 1010270)

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-106


4. Troubleshooting

c) If the problem occurs, replace the drive main (JC9300448A).

(Refer to 3.3.13. Main Drive Unit)

4-107 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
M1-3122

Error message
Tray 1 cassette is pulled out. Insert it properly.

Symptom
Tray 1 is pulled out or the auto size sensor connector is not connected or broken.

Troubleshooting method
1) Remove Tray1 .

2) Insert the corresponding cassette correctly.

3) If Tray1 is not locked or pulled out without holding the locking lever, remove Tray1.

4) Check if foreign substance or paper is inside Tray1. If so, please remove it.

5) If the problem persists, check that auto size sensor is connected properly.
(Refer to 3.3.19. Auto Size sensor)

6) If the problem persists, replace the main board(JC9202430A).

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-108


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
M1-3222

Error message
Tray 2 cassette is pulled out. Insert it properly.

Symptom
Tray 2 is pulled out or the auto size sensor connector is not connected or broken.

Troubleshooting method
1) Remove Tray2.

2) Insert the corresponding cassette correctly.

3) If Tray2 is not locked or pulled out without holding the locking lever, remove Tray2.

4) Check if foreign substance or paper is inside the Tray2. If so, remove it.

5) If the problem persists, check that auto size sensor is connected properly.
(Refer to 3.3.19. Auto Size sensor)

6) If the problem persists, replace the main board(JC9202430A).

4-109 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
M1-4111

Error message
Input System Failure #M14111 : Pull Tray 1 out and insert it.

Symptom
The paper is not fed from tray1.

Troubleshooting method
1) Remove Tray1 and re-install.

2) If the problem persists, Turn the machine off than on.

3) Check if the connection from pickup drive unit and main board is correctly.

4) Check the pickup drive unit operates correctly.


a) Check the harness connection from pickup drive unit to main board is correctly.
b) By service-mode, check the pickup drive unit operates correctly.
( Diagnostics > Engine Diagnostics > Engine Test Routines > 100-0370)

c) If the problem occurs, replace the pickup drive unit(JC93-00442A).


(Refer to 3.3.14. Pick-up Drive Unit)

5) If the problem persists, check the pickup unit.


a) Check the photo sensor in the pickup unit is defective.

b) Check the sensor operates correctly.


c) If the problem occurs, replace the photo sensor(0604001393)

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-110


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
M1-4211

Error message
Input System Failure #M1-4211 : Pull Tray 2 out and insert it.

Symptom
The paper is not fed from tray 2.

Troubleshooting method
1) Remove Tray 2 and re-install.

2) If the problem persists, Turn the machine off than on.

3) Check if the connection from pickup drive unit and main board is correctly.

4) Check the pickup drive unit operates correctly.


a) Check the harness connection from pickup drive unit to main board is correctly.
b) By service-mode, check the pickup drive unit operates correctly.
( Diagnostics > Engine Diagnostics > Engine Test Routines > 100-0370)
c) If the problem occurs, replace the pickup drive unit(JC93-00442A).
(Refer to 3.3.14. Pick-up Drive Unit)

5) If the problem persists, check the pickup unit.


a) Check the photo sensor in the pickup unit is defective.

b) Check the sensor operates correctly.


c) If the problem occurs, replace the photo sensor(0604001393)

4-111 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
M15111
M1-5112

Error message
Paper is low in Tray 1. Load paper.
Paper is empty in Tray 1. Load paper.

Symptom
Paper in the tray is less than 10% of specification. / The photo sensor is defective.

Troubleshooting method
1) Remove Tray 2 and re-install.

2) Load the paper in Tray 2.

3) If paper is loaded but error message has not disappeared, check the following.
(Refer to 3.3.24. Pick-Up Unit and Sensor)
a) If the photo sensor is contaminated, clean it.

b) If the photo sensor is defective, replace it(0604001393).


c) If the actuator is defective, replace it(JC66-03199A).

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-112


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
M15211
M15212

Error message
Paper is low in Tray 2. Load paper.
Paper is empty in Tray 2. Load paper.

Symptom
Paper in the tray is less than 10% of specification. / The photo sensor is defective.

Troubleshooting method
1) Remove Tray 2 and re-install.

2) Load the paper in Tray 2.

3) If paper is loaded but error message has not disappeared, check the following.
(Refer to 3.3.24. Pick-Up Unit and Sensor)
a) If the photo sensor is contaminated, clean it.

b) If the photo sensor is defective, replace it(0604001393).


c) If the actuator is defective, replace it(JC66-03199A).

4-113 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
M15612

Error message
Paper is empty in MP Tray. Load paper.

Symptom
Paper in the MP tray is less than 10%. / The photo sensor is defective.

Troubleshooting method
1) Remove MP Tray and re-install.

2) Load the paper in the tray.

3) If paper is loaded but error message has not disappeared, check the following.
(Refer to 3.3.22.3. MP unit)
a) If the photo sensor is contaminated, clean it.
b)

c) If the photo sensor is defective, replace it(0604001393).

3
d) If the actuator is defective, replace it(JC66-03217A).

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-114


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
M21124
M21125

Error message
Paper jam inside of machine.

Symptom
Paper jam has occurred inside the machine. (Feed drive unit is defective / Feed 1 sensor is defective.)

Troubleshooting method
M21124 : The leading edge of the paper has not reached the feed 1 sensor within the specified time.

M2-1125 : The paper has not left from the feed 1 sensor within the specified time.

1) Open the side cover. Remove the jammed paper.

2) If jammed paper occurs continually, check the following.


a) Enter SVC mode. Execute feed motor test. If the motor operation is normal, go to step d).
b) Remove the rear cover. Check if the feed motor cable is connected correctly.
c) If the connection is OK, replace the feed drive unit(JC93-00448A).
(Refer to 3.3.13. Main Drive Unit)

d) If the feed motor operation is normal, check the feed 1 sensor.


e) If the sensor operation is abnormal, check the harness.

f) If the connection is OK, replace the feed sensor(0604-001381).


(Refer to 3.3.25. Feed sensor)

4-115 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
M21134
M21135

Error message
Paper jam inside of machine.

Symptom
Paper jam has occurred inside the machine. (Feed drive unit is defective / Feed 2 sensor is defective.)

Troubleshooting method
M21134 : The leading edge of the paper has not reached the feed 2 sensor within the specified time.

M2-1135 : The paper has not left from the feed 2 sensor within the specified time.

1) Open the side cover. Remove the jammed paper.

2) If jammed paper occurs continually, check the following.


a) Enter SVC mode. Execute feed motor test. If the motor operation is normal, go to step d).
b) Remove the rear cover. Check if the feed motor cable is connected correctly.
c) If the connection is OK, replace the feed drive unit(JC93-00448A).
(Refer to 3.3.13. Main Drive Unit)

d) If the feed motor operation is normal, check the feed 2 sensor.


e) If the sensor operation is abnormal, check the harness.

f) If the connection is OK, replace the feed sensor 2 (0604-001381).


(Refer to 3.3.26. Feed Unit)

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-116


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
M21211
M21213
M21214

Error message
Paper jam inside of machine.

Symptom
Paper jam has occurred inside the machine. (Regi. roller drive is defective / Regi. sensor is defective.)

Troubleshooting method
M21211 : When the machine is warming-up, jammed paper inside machine is detected.

M21213 : The leading edge of the paper has not reached the regi. sensor within the specified time.

M2-1214 : The paper has not left the regi. sensor within the specified time.

1) Open the side cover. Remove the jammed paper.

2) If the jammed paper occurs continually, check the following.


a) Enter SVC mode. Execute regi. motor test. If the motor operation is normal, go to step d).
b) Remove the rear cover. Check if the Regi/MP motor cable is connected correctly.
c) If the connection is OK, replace the feed drive unit(JC93-00448A).
(Refer to 3.3.13. Main Drive Unit)

d) If the motor operation is normal, check the regi. sensor.


e) If the sensor operation is abnormal, check the harness.
f) If the connection is OK, replace the regi. sensor (0604-001381).
(Refer to 3.3.27. Registration Unit)

4-117 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
M21331
M21333
M21334
M22111
M22113
M22114

Error message
Paper jam inside of machine
Paper jam at the top of duplex path

Symptom
Paper jam has occurred inside the machine.

Troubleshooting method
1) Open the side cover. Remove jammed paper.

2) If the problem persists, check the following.


a) Check the Regi sensor harness. If the harness is normal, replace the Regi. sensor (0604-001381).
(Refer to 3.3.27. Registration Unit)

b) Check the sensors in the Side Unit. If the harness is normal, replace the defective sensor (0604-001393 ).
(Refer to 3.3.22.1. Fuser out sensor / 3.3.22.2. Duplex sensor and Curl sensor)

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-118


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
M31411

Error message
Paper jam in exit area.

Symptom
Paper jam has occurred around the fuser unit.(At power-on / warm up , the machine detected paper jam in Inner
tray Exit Sensor.)

Troubleshooting method
M31413 : The leading edge of the paper has not reached the feed 1 sensor within the specified time.

M3-1414 : The paper has not escaped from the feed 1 sensor within the specified time.

1) Open the side cover. Remove the jammed paper.

2) If the problem persists, check the following.


a) Open the side cover. Check if the connector is connected properly.

b) Remove the JOB-SEPARATOR. Check if the photo sensor is assembled correctly.

c) Check if ACTUATOR-EXIT is assembled correctly. If the ACTUATOR-EXIT (JC66-02533A) is deformed or


broken, replace it.

d) If the photo sensor(0604-001393) is defective, replace it.

4-119 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
M31413
M31414

Error message
Paper jam in exit area.

Symptom
Paper jam has occurred around the fuser unit.(Job separator connection is defective. / Actuator-Exit is defective.)

Troubleshooting method
1) Open the side cover. Remove the jammed paper.

2) If the problem persists, check the following.


a) Open the side cover. Check if the connector is connected properly.

b) Remove the JOB-SEPARATOR. Check if the photo sensor is assembled correctly.

c) Check if ACTUATOR-EXIT is assembled correctly. If the ACTUATOR-EXIT (JC66-02533A) is deformed or


broken, replace it.

d) If the photo sensor(0604-001393) is defective, replace it.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-120


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
M32230
M32430

Error message
Output tray is full. Remove printed media.

Symptom
There is too much paper in output bin tray or inner tray.

Troubleshooting method
M3-2230 : There is too much paper in output bin tray.

M3-2430 : There is too much paper in inner tray.

1) Remove the paper on output bin tray or inner tray.

2) If this error ccurs continually, check the following.


a) Check if the bin-full sensor and actuator is assembled correctly.

b) Check if the bin-full sensor(0604001393) is defective.

4-121 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

4.5.6. Sx-xxxx type error code

Error Code
S11113

Error message
Video System Failure #S1-1113: Turn off then on.

Symptom
The system has some problems due to CPU overheating.

Troubleshooting method
1) Turn the machine off.

2) Wait until the machine is cool, and then turn the machine on.

3) If the problem persists, replace the main board(JC92-02452A).


(Refer to 2.11.1. Main Controller)

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-122


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
S11114

Error message
Video System Failure #S1-1114: Turn off then on.

Symptom
CPU fan is not working

Troubleshooting method
1) Turn the machine off.

2) Wait until the machine is cool. And then turn the machine on.

3) If the problem persists, replace the CPU fan.


(Refer to 2.11.1. Main Controller)

4-123 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
S11313

Error message
The clock became initial time. Set a time again.

Symptom
Saved time is invalid

Troubleshooting method
1) Set up the time and reboot the machine.
(Machine Setup > General Setting > Date and Time)

2) if the problem persists, measure the battery voltage.


a) Remove the rear cover.
(Refer to 3.2.2. Rear Cover)

b) Remove cover from Main PBA.

c) Measure the battery voltage. If value is under 3V, battery is abnormal.

3) If battery has no problem, replace the main board(JC9202452A).

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-124


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
S11411
S11413

Error message
Video System Failure #S1-1411: Turn off then on.
Video System Failure #S1-1413: Turn off then on.

Symptom
SPGPv4Chip is not working.

Troubleshooting method
1) Turn the machine off then on.

2) If the problem persists, replace the main board(JC9202452A).


(Refer to 2.11.1. Main Controller)

4-125 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
S12111

Error message
Video System Failure #S1-2111: Turn off then on.

Symptom
The machine cant detect memory during booting.

Troubleshooting method
1) Turn the machine off then on.

2) If the problem persists, replace the main board(JC9202452A).


(Refer to 2.11.1. Main Controller)

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-126


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
S12411
S12421
S12422

Error message
HDD System Failure #S1-2411: Turn off then on.
HDD System Failure #S1-2421: Turn off then on.
HDD System Failure #S1-2422: Turn off then on.

Symptom
Hard Disk is not installed in the machine. / Hard Disk is defective.

Troubleshooting method
1) Check if the HDD is installed correctly.
a) Remove the reat cover
(Refer to 3.3.2. Rear Cover)
b) Check the cable connection.
(Refer to 2.11.1. Main Controller)

2) If the problem persists, replace the HDD(JC59-00035A).

4-127 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
S12510
S12511
S12521
S12523
S12540

Error message
MSOK System Failure #S1-2510: Turn off then on.
MSOK System Failure #S1-2511: Turn off then on.
MSOK Failure: #S1-2521. Call for service.
PPM data is incorrect. Call for service & change MSOK.
MSOK Failure: #S1-2540. Call for service & change MSOK.

Symptom
Communication error between data storage device of MSOK and main board has occurred.

Troubleshooting method
1) Check if the MSOK is inserted correctly. Remove and reinstall it..
a) Remove the reat cover
(Refer to 3.3.2. Rear Cover)

b) Check if the MSOK is correctly connected.

c) Check if the connecter and harness are correctly plugged.


(Refer to 2.11.1. Main Controller)

2) If the problem persists, replace the main board(JC92-02452A).

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-128


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
S14111

Error message
Video System Failure #S1-4111: Turn off then on.

Symptom
The main board cant send the data through the network channel. Network cable is not connected.

Troubleshooting method
1) Turn the machine off then on.

2) Check if the network harness and connector are correctly connected.


a) Insert the network harness to connector rightly.
b) Check the LED light near the network connector.
- If it is connected correctly, green lamp is turn on.
- If not, the orange lamp is flickers.

3) If the problem is persists, replace the main board(JC92-02452A).

4-129 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
S14311

Error message
Video System Failure #S1-4311: Turn off then on.

Symptom
USB unit chip is abnormal.

Troubleshooting method
1) Turn the machine off then on.

2) If the problem persists, replace the main board(JC92-02452A).


(Refer to 2.11.1. Main Controller)

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-130


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
S15521

Error message
FDI device is not installed. Install the device.

Symptom
The machine cant detect the FDI device.

Troubleshooting method
1) Install the FDI device.

2) If the FDI device is already installed, update the firmware for main board.
(Refer to 4.3. Firmware Update)

3) Check the connection between FDI device and main board.


a) Remove the rear cover.
(Refer to 3.3.2. Rear Cover)
b) Check the connection between FDI unit and mainboard connection.
(Refer to 2.11.1. Main Controller

4) If FDI unit has problem, replace FDI unit(CLX-KIT10).

5) If the problem persists, replace the main board(JC92-02452A).

4-131 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
S21211

Error message
Engine System Failure #S2-1211: Turn off then on.

Symptom
Power chip on main board is defective.

Troubleshooting method
1) Turn the machine off then on.

2) If the problem persists, replace the main board.


(Refer to 2.11.1. Main Controller)

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-132


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
S22311

Error message
Engine System Failure #S2-2311: Turn off then on.

Symptom
EEPROM on main board is defective

Troubleshooting method
1) Turn the machine off then on.

2) If the problem persists, replace the main board.


(Refer to 2.11.1. Main Controller)

4-133 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
S24210

Error message
Front door is open. Close it.

Symptom
Front cove is opened.

Troubleshooting method
1) Close the front cover correctly.

2) Check if the cover open sensor connector is connected properly. Reconnect it.

3) If the sensor is defective, replace it.


(Refer to 3.3.31. Front Cover Open Switch)

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-134


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
S24410

Error message
Right door is open. Close it.

Symptom
Side cover is opened.

Troubleshooting method
1) Close the side cover correctly.

2) Check if the cover open sensor connector is connected properly. Reconnect it.

3) If the sensor is defective, replace it.


(Refer to 3.3.30. Side Cover Open Switch)

4-135 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
S33111

Error message
Scan System Failure #S3-3111: Turn off then on.

Symptom
Error occurs at Scanner connection

Troubleshooting method
1) Turn the power off then turn on.

2) If the problem persists, remove the DADF unit.


(Refer to 3.3.283 DADF Unit)

3) Open the scan rear cover.


(Refer to 3.3.29.1. Scanner Board)

4) Check if the connection onthe Scanner board.

5) If there is no problem, replace the Main board(JC92-02452A) or Scan joint board(JC9202447A).

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-136


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
S33121

Error message
Scanner locked or another problem occurred.(No Switch Case)Scanner is locked.

Symptom
Scanner module does not move.

Troubleshooting method
1) Turn the power off then turn on.

2) If the problem persists, remove the DADF unit.


(Refer to 3.3.283 DADF Unit)

1) Press the cover-open sensor.

2) If the problem persists, Open the scanner glass and check the module
(Refer to 3.3.29.2 Scanner glass)

3) If the module is moved, check if the motor is connected correctly.

4) If the connection is OK, replace the Main board(JC9202452A) or Scan joint board)(JC9202447A).

4-137 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
S33211
S33213
S33214
S33215
S33216
S33217

Error message
Scan System Failure #S3-3211: Turn off then on.
Scan System Failure #S3-3213: Turn off then on.
Scan System Failure #S3-3214: Turn off then on.
Scan System Failure #S3-3215: Turn off then on.
Scan System Failure #S3-3216: Turn off then on.
Scan System Failure #S3-3217: Turn off then on.

Symptom
DADF is not connected communication error occurs with CIP6 board.

Troubleshooting method
1) Turn the power off then turn on.

2) If the problem persists, check the DADF unit connection.


(Refer to 3.3.283 DADF Unit)

3) If the problem persists, remove the DADF unit to find the defects.
(Refer to 3.3.28. DADF Unit)

4) Remove the DADF rear cover. Check if the connector on DADF board is connected correctly.
(Refer to 3.3.29.1. Scanner board)

5) If the connection is OK, replace the DADF board(JC9202446A).

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-138


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
S53111

Error message
UI System Failure #S5-3111:Turn off then on.

Symptom
Communication error between main board and OPE board has occurred.

Troubleshooting method
1) Turn the power off then turn on.

2) If the problem persists, check the following.

3) Check the connection between main board and OPE board.


(Refer to 3.3.7. OPE Unit)
(Refer to 3.3.8. Main Board)

4) If the connection is OK, replace the main board(JC92-02452A) or OPE board(JC97-04006B).

4-139 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
S63122

Error message
Network cable is disconnected. Check it.

Symptom
Network cable is disconnected. .

Troubleshooting method
1) Turn the machine off then on.

2) Check if the network harness and connector are correctly connected.


a) Insert the network harness to connector rightly.
b) Check the LED light near the network connector.
- If it is connected correctly, green lamp is turn on.
- If not, the orange lamp is flickers.

3) If the problem is persists, replace the main board(JC92-02452A).

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-140


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
S63123

Error message
This IP address conflicts with that of other system. Check it.

Symptom
Network error. (IP address conflicts with that of another system or Communication error)

Troubleshooting method
Change the IP adredd
(Machine Setup > Network Setting > Login > TCP/IP > Select the network protocol > IP Setting

4-141 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
S63128

Error message
802.1x authentication failed. Please Contact the System Administrator

Symptom
There is no response when checking the ping test. ID or Password is incorrect.

Troubleshooting method
1) Change the IP adredd
(Machine Setup > Network Setting > Login > TCP/IP > Select the network protocol > IP Setting

2) Inut the Network Login ID and Password correctly.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-142


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
S72110

Error message
Fuser Failure: #S7-2110. Turn off then on

Symptom
The fuser unit is overheated.

Troubleshooting method
1) Turn the machine off. Re-install the fuser unit. Then turn the machine on.
(Refer to 3.2.2 Fuser unit)

2) Remove the fuser unit. After open the jam cover, check jammed or wrapped paper is in the fuser unit.
(Refer to 3.3.23. Fuser unit)

3) Check if the contact type thermistor(1404001567) or Non-contact type thermistor(1404001453)is broken.

4) If the problem persists, replace the Fuser unit(110V : JC9101049A / 220V : JC9101050A).

5) If the problem persists, replace the Main board(JC92-02452A) or FDB board(110V : JC44-00210A, 220V :
JC44-00211A), SMPS(110V : JC44-00093A, 220V : JC44-00100A)

4-143 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

4.5.7. Ux-xxxx type error code

Error Code
U12113
U12119

Error message
Fuser Unit Failure: #U1-2113.
Fuser Unit Failure: #U1-2119.

Symptom
The thermistor cant measure temperature. The hear-roller will not heat-up.

Troubleshooting method
U12113 : Error occurs at non-contact type Thermistor

U12119 : Error occurs at contact type Thermistor

1) Turn the machine off. Re-install the fuser unit, then turn the machine on.
(Refer to 3.2.2 Fuser unit)

2) Remove the fuser unit. After opening the jam cover, check if jammed or wrapped paper is in the fuser unit.

3) If the problem persists, check the following:


(Refer to 3.3.23. Fuser unit)
a) Check if the Halogen lamp (110V : 4713001632 / 220V : 4713001633) is broken or disconnected.
b) Check if the AC connection of the Halogen lamp is disconnected or contaminated.

c) Check if the thermistat(4712-001098) is disconnected.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-144


4. Troubleshooting

d) Check if the contact type thermistor(1404001567) or Non-contact type thermistor(1404001453)is broken.

4) If the problem persists, replace the Fuser unit(110V : JC9101049A / 220V : JC9101050A).

5) If the problem persists, replace the Main board(JC92-02452A) or FDB board(110V : JC44-00210A, 220V :
JC44-00211A), SMPS(110V : JC44-00093A, 220V : JC44-00100A)

4-145 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
U12115

Error message
Fuser Unit Failure: #U1-2115. Turn off then on.

Symptom
The pressure control unit(Cam unit)of the fuser is abnormal.

Troubleshooting method
1) Turn the machine off. Re-install the fuser unit, then turn the machine on.
(Refer to 3.2.2. Fuser Unit)

2) If the problem persists, check the following:s


(Refer to 3.3.23. Fuser Unit)
a) When the side-cover closes, check if the operation sound of the pressure control unit occurs.
b) Check if the parts of the pressure control unit are abnormal.
- Check if the shape of the CAM-REAR(JC6603178A) is broken.
- Check if there are abnormal parts of the pressure control unit.

c) Check if the fuser-motor is abnormal via service-mode.


(Diagnostics > Engine Diagnostics > Engine Test Routines > 1090140)

3) If the problem persists, replace the Fuser unit(110V : JC9101063A, 220V : JC9101064A)

4) If the problem persists, replace the pressure control unit or cam-motor or Main board(JC92-02452A).

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-146


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
U12132
U12135

Error message
Fuser Unit Failure: #U1-2132.
Fuser Unit Failure: #U1-2135.

Symptom
Temperature of the fuser rises abnormally.

Troubleshooting method
U12132 : Error occurs at non-contact type Thermistor

U12135 : Error occurs at contact type Thermistor

1) Turn the machine off. Re-install the fuser unit, then turn the machine on.
(Refer to 3.2.2. Fuser unit)

2) Check if the power voltage is normal. (Is the voltage during the operation 10% of the rated voltage?)

3) Remove the fuser unit. After opening the jam cover, check jammed or wrapped paper is in the fuser unit.

4) If the problem persists, Check the following:


(Refer to 3.3.23. Fuser unit)
a) Check if the Halogen lamp (110V : 4713001632 / 220V : 4713001633) is broken or disconnected.
b) Check if the AC connection of the Halogen lamp is disconnected or contaminated.

c) Check if the thermistat(4712-001098) is disconnected.

4-147 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

d) Check if the contact type thermistor(1404001567) or Non-contact type thermistor(1404001453) is broken.

5) If the problem persists, replace the Fuser unit(110V : JC9101049A / 220V : JC9101050A).

6) If the problem persists, replace the Main board(JC92-02452A) or FDB board(110V : JC44-00210A, 220V :
JC44-00211A), SMPS(110V : JC44-00093A, 220V : JC44-00100A)

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-148


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
U12141
U12142

Error message
Fuser Unit Failure: #U1-2141.
Fuser Unit Failure: #U1-2142.

Symptom
Temperature of the thermistor is higher than the maximum allowable temperature.

Troubleshooting method
U12141 : Error occurs at non-contact type Thermistor

U12142 : Error occurs at contact type Thermistor

1) Turn the machine off. Re-install the fuser unit, then turn the machine on.
(Refer to 3.2.2. Fuser unit)

2) Check if the power voltage is normal. (Is the voltage during the operation 10% of the rated voltage?)

3) Remove the fuser unit. After opening the jam cover, check if jammed or wrapped paper is in the fuser unit.

4) If the problem persists, Check the following:


(Refer to 3.3.23. Fuser unit)
a) Check if the contact type thermistor(1404001567) or Non-contact type thermistor(1404001453) is broken.

5) If the problem persists, replace the Fuser unit(110V : JC9101049A / 220V : JC9101050A).

6) If the problem persists, replace the Main board(JC92-02452A) or FDB board(110V : JC44-00210A, 220V :
JC44-00211A), SMPS(110V : JC44-00093A, 220V : JC44-00100A)

4-149 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
U12316
U12317

Error message
Fuser Unit Failure: #U1-2316.
Fuser Unit Failure: #U1-2317.

Symptom
Temperature of the fuser changes abnormally

Troubleshooting method
U12316 : Error occurs at non-contact type Thermistor

U12317 : Error occurs at contact type Thermistor

1) Turn the machine off. Re-install the fuser unit, then turn the machine on.
(Refer to 3.2.2. Fuser unit)

2) Check if the power voltage is normal. (Is the voltage during the operation 10% of the rated voltage?)

3) If the problem persists, Check the following:


(Refer to 3.3.23. Fuser unit)
a) Check if the Halogen lamp (110V : 4713001632 / 220V : 4713001633) is broken or disconnected.
b) Check if the AC connection of the Halogen lamp is disconnected or contaminated.

c) Check if the thermistat(4712-001098) is disconnected.

d) Check if the contact type thermistor(1404001567) or Non-contact type thermistor(1404001453) is broken.

4) If the problem persists, replace the Fuser unit(110V : JC9101049A / 220V : JC9101050A).

5) If the problem persists, replace the Main board(JC92-02452A) or FDB board(110V : JC44-00210A, 220V :
JC44-00211A), SMPS(110V : JC44-00093A, 220V : JC44-00100A)

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-150


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
U12335
U1233A

Error message
Fuser Unit Failure: #U1-2335.
Fuser Unit Failure: #U1-233A.

Symptom
Temperature of the thermistor is abnormally low.

Troubleshooting method
U12335 : Error occurs at non-contact type Thermistor

U1233A : Error occurs at contact type Thermistor

1) Turn the machine off. Re-install the fuser uni, then turn the machine on.
(Refer to 3.3.2. Fuser unit)

2) Check if the power voltage is normal. (Is the voltage during the operation 10% of the rated voltage?)

3) Remove the fuser unit. After opening the jam cover, check if jammed or wrapped paper is in the fuser unit.

4) If the problem persists, Check the follows.


(Refer to 3.3.23. Fuser unit)
a) Check if the Halogen lamp (110V : 4713001632 / 220V : 4713001633) is broken or disconnected.
b) Check if the AC connection of the Halogen lamp is disconnected or contaminated.

c) Check if the thermistat(4712-001098) is disconnected.

4-151 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

d) Check if the contact type thermistor(1404001567)or Non-contact type thermistor(1404001453) is broken.

5) If the problem persists, replace the Fuser unit(110V : JC9101049A / 220V : JC9101050A).

6) If the problem persists, replace the Main board(JC92-02452A) or FDB board(110V : JC44-00210A, 220V :
JC44-00211A), SMPS(110V : JC44-00093A, 220V : JC44-00100A)

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-152


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
U12337
U1233D

Error message
Fuser Unit Failure: #U1-2337.
Fuser Unit Failure: #U1-233D.

Symptom
When the fuser warms-up, the temperature of the thermistor is abnormally low.

Troubleshooting method
U12337 : Error occurs at non-contact type Thermistor

U1233D : Error occurs at contact type Thermistor

1) Turn the machine off. Re-install the fuser unit, then turn the machine on.
(Refer to 3.2.2 Fuser unit)

2) Check if the power voltage is normal. (Is the voltage during the operation 10% of the rated voltage?)

3) Remove the fuser unit. After opening the jam cover, check if jammed or wrapped paper is in the fuser unit.

4) If the problem persists, Check the follows.


(Refer to 3.3.23. Fuser unit)
a) Check if the Halogen lamp (110V : 4713001632 / 220V : 4713001633) is broken or disconnected.
b) Check if the AC connection of the Halogen lamp is disconnected or contaminated.

c) Check if the thermistat(4712-001098) is disconnected.

4-153 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

d) Check if the contact type thermistor(1404001567)or Non-contact type thermistor(1404001453) is broken.

5) If the problem persists, replace the Fuser unit(110V : JC9101049A / 220V : JC9101050A).

6) If the problem persists, replace the Main board(JC92-02452A) or FDB board(110V : JC44-00210A, 220V :
JC44-00211A), SMPS(110V : JC44-00093A, 220V : JC44-00100A)

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-154


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
U21111
U21112
U21113
U21114

Error message
LSU Failure: #U2-1111. Turn off then on.
LSU Failure: #U2-1112. Turn off then on.
LSU Failure: #U2-1113. Turn off then on.
LSU Failure: #U2-1114. Turn off then on.

Symptom
LSU motor does not operate of it operates abnormally. Motor ready signal is abnormal.

Troubleshooting method
1) Turn the machine off then on. Check for the LSU motor operation sound during warm-up.

2) Print a Demo page and check the printout is normal.

3) If the problem persists, check the following:


(Refer to 3.3.3. LSU)

4-155 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

If the LSU motor makes a sound,


a) By SVC mode, Check if the motor ready signal is occurred.
(Diagnostics > Engine Diagnostics > Engine Test Routines > 1100000)

b) If not, open the side-cover and replace the LSU(JC9704017A)

If the LSU motor does not make a sound,


a) Unplug and reconnect the LSU flat cable connecting the LSU. Then check the operation sound of LSU.

b) Unplug and reconnect the LSU flat cable on main board. Then check the operation sound of LSU.

c) If the LSU flat cable is defective, replace FFC(JC3901657A)


d) If the LSU cable is OK, replace the LSU(JC9704017A)

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-156


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
U33113
U33211
U33212
U33213
U33214
U33312
U33314

Error message
Original paper jam inside of scanner

Symptom
Jam has occurred inside the DADF unit.

Troubleshooting method
1) Open the DADF cover. If there is jammed paper, remove it.
(Refer to 3.3.28.2. DADF Open Cover)

2) If this error occurs continually, check the DADF regi. sensor(0604-001393) and regi actuator(JC6603148A). If
their operation is abnormal, replace a defective part.

3) If the regi sensor is OK, check the scan sensor(0604-001393) and scan actuator(JC6603210A). If their operation is
abnormal, replace a defective part.

4) Check if the regi. clutch operates normally. Check if the clutch cable is connected correctly. If the
clutch(JC4700033A) is defective, replace it.

4-157 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
U33411
U33413
U33414

Error message
Original paper jam inside of scanner.

Symptom
Jam has occurred inside the DADF unit.

Troubleshooting method
1) Open the DADF cover. If there is jammed paper, remove it.
(Refer to 3.3.28.2. DADF Open Cover)

2) If this error occurs continually, check the following:


a) Check if the Regi. actuator(JC6603148A) operates normally.

b) Check if the Regi. sensor cable is connected correctly.


c) If the connection is OK, replace the Regi. sensor(0604-001393).

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-158


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
U33311
U33313

Error message
Original paper jam inside of scanner.

Symptom
Jam has occurred inside the DADF unit.

Troubleshooting method
1) Open the DADF cover. If there is jammed paper, remove it.
(Refer to 3.3.28.2. DADF Open Cover)

2) If this error occurs continually, check the following:


a) Check if the scan actuator(JC66-03210A) operates normally.

b) Check if the scan sensor cable is connected correctly.


c) If the connection is OK, replace the scan sensor(0604-001393).

4-159 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
U33711
U33713
U33714

Error message
Original paper jam in the exit area of scanner

Symptom
Original jam has occurred inside the DADF unit.

Troubleshooting method
1) Open the DADF cover. If there is a jammed paper, remove it.
(Refer to 3.3.28.2. DADF Open Cover)

2) If this error occurs continually, check the followings.


a) Check if the exit actuator(JC66-03184A) operates normally.

b) Check if the exit sensor cable is connected correctly.


c) If the connection is OK, replace the exit sensor(0604-001393).

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-160


4. Troubleshooting

Error Code
U34210

Error message
Top door of scanner is open.

Symptom
DADF cover is opened.

Troubleshooting method
1) Close the DADF cover perfectly.

2) If this error occurs continually, Check the followings.


a) Check the DADF cover open sensor(0604-001393) and its harness. If there is a defective part, replace it.
b) If both of them are normal, check the Cover-Open Rib. If it is broken, replace the Cover-Open(JC63-03273A).

4-161 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

4.6. Image quality problems and solutions

Print-quality defects can be attributed to printer components, consumables, media, internal software, external software
applications and environmental conditions.

To successfully troubleshoot print-quality problems, as many variables as possible must be eliminated.

The first step is to generate prints using printable pages embedded in the printer on laser paper. The paper should be from
an unopened ream that has been acclimated to room temperature and you should ensure that genuine Samsung Toner
is installed in the printer.

Samsung A/S chart (A3)

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-162


4. Troubleshooting

[1] Grid pattern For adjusting margin and magnification


[2] Black patches For adjusting skew error
[3] Barcode For checking the reproduction of barcode
[4] Note area For recording the date, conditions, etc.
[A] Halftone band For checking banding and jitter (K 50%)
[B, L] Resolution patterns For checking resolution
[C, D, Images For checking color reproduction
E]
[F] Map image For checking fine line reproduction
[G] Color patches For checking color reproduction and uniformity
[H] Gradation pattern For checking tone reproduction of 7 colors (C, M, Y, K, R, G, B/ 10~100%)
[I] Color/Mono text For checking the reproduction of color, mono text
[J] Multilingual Feature For checking the reproduction of small text
[K] White Gap pattern For checking color to color, color to mono white gap
[M] Rulers For checking the magnification error (unit : cm)
[N] Rulers For checking the magnification error (unit : inch)

4-163 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

How to analysis the defect image


See the next flow chart.

TIP

1) According to the part remain life, cause can vary. Check the part remain life.

2) Check the defect whether periodic or not.

P O W E R !O N

C h e c k ! S e t ! S t a t u s ! & ! P a r t s ! L if e
1 .! C h e c k !O P E ! L E D
2 .! P r i n t ! R e p o r t
3 .! P r in t ! T e s t ! P a g e

A n y !I m a g e !
D e fe c t?

zft

A s s u m e !D e f e c t ! T y p e ! & !
C au ses

op T e s t !a ! c a u s e

P r in t !T e s t !
P a g e ,! C le a r ?

zft
V e r if ic a t io n
( 2 ~ 3 !T im e s )

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-164


4. Troubleshooting

4.6.1. Vertical Black Lines

A. Typical faulty images

B. Troubleshooting procedure
Step Check item Action
1 OPC is scratched or contaminated in the vertical Replace Drum unit.
direction. (Refer to 3.2.1.)

2 If Charge Scorotron saw in Developer unit is Clean the Scorotron with the Cleaning bar.
contaminated?

3 If the Charge Scorotron saw is defected? Replace Drum unit.


(Refer to 3.2.1.)

4 Scanner unit is contaminated. Wife the surface of contaminated parts with a soft cloth.
(ADF Glass / Mirror / CCD Sensor)

4-165 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Step Check item Action


(Refer to 3.3.29.)

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-166


4. Troubleshooting

4.6.2. Vertical Light or White Lines

A. Typical faulty images

B. Troubleshooting procedure
Step Check item Action
1 Some foreign substance is stuck between DR and Blade. Remove foreign substances.
No toner on DR partially.

Make the hook (Transparency sheet is recommended.)


Put the hook into the gap between DR and Blade.
Pull out foreign substances.
2 Developer is empty Replace Developer unit.
Check the toner remain on Report page.
Check the toner layer on Roller-Magnetic is uniform or
not.
(Refer to 3.2.2.2.)

4-167 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

Step Check item Action


3 The path of Laser beam is blocked. Clean the LSU window.
(Foreign substance is on the LSU window.)

4 OPC is scratched or contaminated in the vertical Replace Drum unit.


direction. (Refer to 3.2.1.)

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-168


4. Troubleshooting

4.6.3. Horizontal Periodic Black Lines, Dots.

A. Typical faulty images

B. Troubleshooting procedure
Step Check item Action
1 Poor connection between CR terminal and Set. Wipe out the surface of contaminated CR terminal.

2 Poor charge voltage of HVPS (MHV) Check the connection between MHV terminal and
connector.
Replace HVPS.
(Refer to 3.3.5.)

4-169 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

4.6.4. Horizontal Periodic Light/Dark Lines, Dots.

A. Typical faulty images

B. Troubleshooting procedure
Step Check item Action
1 Horizontal periodic bands (OPC, 94.2mm) As some time passes, most of bands will disappear.
OPC was exposed for long hours. Replace Drum unit.
Damaged by high voltage in a short time. (Refer to 3.2.1.)
2 Horizontal periodic Light/Dark bands (Roller-Magnetic, Replace Deve unit.
35.7mm) (Refer to 3.2.2.)
Roller-Magnetic is inferior in quality.
V-groove of the surface of Roller-Magnetic is not
uniform.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-170


4. Troubleshooting

4.6.5. Blurred image

A. Typical faulty images

B. Troubleshooting procedure
Step Check item Action
1 Humidity of the circumstances and paper. Change to the new and better grade paper.
2 Thv transfer voltage is low. Turn up the THV transfer voltage.
(Refer to 4.4.6.7.)
3 Connection between HVPS and THV is incorrect. Check if the connection between THV high voltage
terminal and HVPS THV terminal is correct.
Check if the connection of HVPS and TR correct.

4-171 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

4.6.6. Foggy image

A. Typical faulty images

B. Troubleshooting procedure
Step Check item Action
1 Voltage of OPC is abnormally low. Replace Drum unit.
(Refer to 3.2.1.)
2 Toner is over supplied by abnormal TC sensor. Replace the Toner cartridge.
(Refer to 3.2.2.)
3 T1 Voltage is abnormally high Check the connection in HVPS.
Connection of Transfer rollers in THV, TR
Replace HVPS.
(Refer to 3.3.5.)
4 HVPS operates abnormally. Replace HVPS.
HVPS is damaged or broken. (Refer to 3.3.5.)

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-172


4. Troubleshooting

4.6.7. Light image

A. Typical faulty images

B. Troubleshooting procedure
Step Check item Action
1 Occur the poor Transfer. Replace HVPS.
(Refer to 3.3.5.)
2 Output voltage of HVPS is abnormally low. Replace HVPS.
Color density becomes low. (Refer to 3.3.5.)
3 TC Sensor operates abnormally. Replace Toner cartridge.
(Refer to 3.2.1.)

4-173 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

4.6.8. Uneven pitch and jitter image

A. Typical faulty images

P a p e r fe e d in g
d ire c tio n

B. Troubleshooting procedure
Step Check item Action
1 Under 3mm periodic jitters or horizontal bands has Remove foreign substances at the drive gears.
occurred. Apply grease.
- Toner cartridge gears.

- OPC unit gears.

- Main drive unit gears.


Replace the abnormal units.
- Toner cartridge.
- Drum unit.
- Main drive unit.
2 Under 1mm periodic jitter or horizontal bands has Check if the LSU is assembled incorrectly, replace the
occurred. screws.
Replace LSU
(Refer to 3.3.3.)

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-174


4. Troubleshooting

4.6.9. Skewed image

A. Typical faulty images

B. Troubleshooting procedure
Step Check item Action
1 Is the cassette properly installed? Reinstall the cassette properly.
2 Is too much paper loaded in the cassettes? Reduce paper.
3 Are the cassette side guides properly set? Adjust the side guides.
4 Is the surface of pick up/ reverse/ forward roller dirty? Clean or replace the contaminated roller.
(Refer to 3.2.5.)
5 Is the transfer belt installed properly? Reinstall ITB unit.
6 Is the DADF installed and adjusted properly? Reinstall the DADF unit.
Adjust DADF skew.
(Refer to 4.7.)

4-175 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

4.6.10. Poor fusing performance

A. Typical faulty images

B. Troubleshooting procedure
Step Check item Action
1 Check the paper type. Check the paper type on control panel is same as paper
Depending on what type of paper used, print speed will user uses.
vary. (Refer to 2.2.7.)
(ex)
- Plain (71~90g/), Thick (91~105g/) : 100%
- Heavy weight (106~175g/) : 50%
- Envelope (75~90 g/), Label (120~150 g/) : 50%
2 The fuser unit is worn out. Replace the fuser unit.
3 Check if the surface of the fuser belt & pressure roller Replace the fuser unit.
is scratched.
4 Check if the temperature control system has problems. Check the Non-contact thermistor sensor.
- Thermistor is broken or operates abnormally
Halogen lamp is broken or operates abnormally.

Check the Halogen lamp.


(Refer to 4.5.7. U12113)
If you find some problems, replace the broken parts or
Fuser unit.
5 Check if the pressure control system operates properly. Check the pressure control system.
(Refer to 4.5.7. U12115)
The problem persists, replace Fuser unit.
6 Paper is wrapped on the Heating roller. Remove a wrapped paper and print the demo page.
If there are some problems on the printout, replace Fuser
unit.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-176


4. Troubleshooting

4.6.11. Stain on the paper back side

A. Typical faulty images

B. Troubleshooting procedure
Step Check item Action
1 Is the transfer roller dirty or worn out? Clean or replace the Transfer roller Assembly.

2 Are the fuser belt and pressure roller dirty? Clean the fuser belt and pressure roller.
3 Check the pressure roller surface is damaged or Replace Fuser unit.
scratched. (Refer to 3.2.2.5.)

4-177 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


4. Troubleshooting

4.7. Adjusting the DADF skew

1) Stand the DADF unit. Loosen 4 screws securing the b) If the skew image is like a below sample, adjust
right hinge unit slightly. the hinge unit down. (1 scale => 0.9 mm skew
adjustment)

2) Adjust the position of the DADF hinge as the skew


status.
a) If the skew image is like a below sample, adjust
the hinge unit upward. (1 scale => 0.9 mm skew
adjustment)

3) Detach the DADF sponge after adjusting the skew.


Place the DADF sponge on platen glass. And then close
the DADF unit to stick the sponge.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 4-178


4. Troubleshooting

4.8. Other errors

1) No-Power
Description : When system power is turned on, LED and LCD on the operator panel do not come on.
Check and cause Solution
The connection between main board and OPE board is bad. Reconnect or replace the harness.
HVPS or SMPS output is abnormal. Replace the HVPS or SMPS board.

2) Calibrating the touch screen (Touch screen model only)


Description : Touch screen does not operate properly.
Check and cause Solution
The linearity value for touch panel has changed due to using 1) Turn off the machine.
a machine long hours or surroundings. 2) While pressing the number 0 on numeric keys, turn the
machine on. Wait until calibration screen appears.
3) Press centre of mark + following order 1~5. Use your
finger. Perform 2 times.

4) If there is no problem, Complete will appear on LCD


and reboot the machine. When making a mistake, start
again from the step 1.

4-179 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


5. System Diagram

5. System Diagram

5.1. Connection Diagram1


000000

000000
nRS T_DC F 1
000000 OP E DC F_TXD 2
DGND 4 1 DGND DC F_RXD 3
DP _MC B 3 2 DP _MC B nC MD_REQ_DC F 4
US B Cable
DM_MC B 2 3 DM_MC B NC 5
nRS T 1 4 nRS T nDETEC T_DC F 6
5V1 _S LP 7
DGND 51 1 DGND
DGND 8
5V1_OP E 50 2 5 V1 _OP E
24 V4 9
5V1_OP E 49 3 5 V1 _OP E
24 V4 10
5V1_OP E 48 4 5 V1 _OP E
24 V4 11
DGND 47 5 DGND
24 V4 12
5V1_OP E 46 6 5 V1 _OP E
DGND 13
5V1_OP E 45 7 5 V1 _OP E
DGND 14
5V1_OP E 44 8 5 V1 _OP E
DGND 15
DGND 43 9 DGND
DGND 16
5V1_OP E 42 10 5 V1 _OP E
nP AP ER_S IZE3 17
5V1_OP E 41 11 5 V1 _OP E
nP AP ER_S IZE4 18
5V1_OP E 40 12 5 V1 _OP E
DGND 39 13 DGND
5V1_OP E 38 14 5 V1 _OP E
5V1_OP E 37 15 5 V1 _OP E
nRS T_F INIS HER 1
5V1_OP E 36 16 5 V1 _OP E
F INIS HER_TXD 2
DGND 35 17 DGND
F INIS HER_RXD 3
5V1_OP E 34 18 5 V1 _OP E
nC MD_REQ_F INIS HER 4
5V1_OP E 33 19 5 V1 _OP E
NC 5
5V1_OP E 32 20 5 V1 _OP E
nDETEC T_F INIS HER 6
DGND 31 21 DGND
5V1 _S LP 7
LVDS3 + 30 22 LVDS3+ Engine DGND 8
LVDS3 - 29 23 LVDS3-
DGND
OP E 28 24 DGND
& 24 V4 9
Main 24 V4 10
LVDS3 _C LK+ 27 25 LVDS3_C LK+
24 V4 11
LVDS3 _C LK- 26 FFC CABLE 26 LVDS3_C LK-
24 V4 12
DGND 25 27 DGND
DGND 13
LVDS2 + 24 28 LVDS2+
DGND 14
LVDS2 - 23 29 LVDS2-
DGND 15
DGND 22 30 DGND
DGND 16
LVDS1 + 21 31 LVDS1+
LVDS1 - 20 32 LVDS1-
DGND 19 33 DGND
LVDS0 + 18 34 LVDS0+
LVDS0 - 17 35 LVDS0- DGND 1
DGND 16 36 DGND DGND 2
OP E_RXD_F F C 15 37 OP E_RXD_F F C 3_3 VS US P 3
OP E_TXD_F F C 14 38 OP E_TXD_F F C 5V2 _S US P 4
DGND 13 39 DGND F DI_nDETEC T 5
nRS T_MIC OM_OP E 12 40 nRS T_MIC OM_OP E F DI_NOT_RDY 6
nMIC OM_BOOT 11 41 nMIC OM_BOOT F DI_EN_C OP Y_EXIT 7
nKEY_S OF T_P WR 10 42 nKEY_S OF T_P WR F DI_nEN_C OP Y_C NT 8
nINT_TS P 9 43 nINT_TS P F DI_nDETEC T_P S IZE 9
DGND 8 44 DGND F DI_nDETEC T_C OLOR 10
S DA2_TS P 7 45 S DA2 _TS P F DI_nEN 11
DGND 6 46 DGND
S C L2_TS P 5 47 S C L2_TS P
DGND 4 48 DGND
3_3VS US P 3 49 3 _3 VS US P
3_3VS US P 2 50 3 _3 VS US P S P EAKER_P 2 2 1 2
S P EAKER_N 1
wire W wire S P EAKER
DGND 1 51 DGND 1 2 1

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 5-1


5. System Diagram

5.2. Connection Diagram2


00000


00000

o o 00000

 o o 
o o
 o o 
o
o o
o   o o  
o o o

o  o o 
o o o o
o
 o o 

o
o o o
o  

o
o
o o




0000000


0000000

0000000


0000000  o 000000


o
o
o 000000


o

000000

o
o


o
o
o
o
o u
o
o o
o
o
o
o o
o
o o
o
o o o
o o

o o o
o o
o o o
o o
o
o
o
o o
o o 
o o
o o
o o
o o
o
o o
o o
 o o
0000000 o
o  o
o o
0000000
o o
o o
0000000

o o
o
o
o

o
o
o
o
o
000000

o
o 000000

o 000000


o 000000

5-2 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


5. System Diagram

5.3. Connection Diagram3


o

o
o

o
 
 o

 o

 o

 o

 o 
 o

o

o

o

o
o
o
o
o
o
o

o
o 
o
o
o
o
o


u
000000

000000

000000


000000


o
o
 o o 
o o
o o
o o
o o
o

o
 o  o
 o  o
 o  o

o
o
  o  o
 o  o
o o
o o
o o
o o

o o
o

o


Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 5-3


5. System Diagram

5.4. Connection Diagram4


o
o  o 
o o
o o o
o o
o  o 

o o

o  o
o  o 

o o

o o




o 
o
o
o 00000

o
00000

o
o 00000

o o

o o
o o
o o
o o
o o



o o
o o


o o
o
o
o
o
o
o


o
o
o o
o
o
o
o
o
o
u o
o
o

o
o
o
o
o o
o
o
o
o
o
o





0000000


0000000

0000000

o o
0000000 o o
o o
o o
 o o 
o o
 o o  o
o o  o 
o
o o
 o o   o 
o o o

 o o   o 
 o o   o

o
o o o
 o o  o
 o o  o
o o 
 o o 
 o o 
o o
o o
o o
o o
o o
o o

5-4 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


6. Reference Information

6. Reference Information
This chapter contains the tools list, list of abbreviations used in this manual, and a guide to the location space required when
installing the printer. A definition of test pages and Wireless Network information definition is also included.

6.1. Tools for Troubleshooting

The following tools are recommended safe and easy troubleshooting as described in this service manual.

Tool Image Use Remark


Hand DVM Checking the fuser lamp. Service
Checking the SMPS fuse.

Spring hook When disassembling the spring Service


Small vacuum To remove the toner and contamination Service
inside of the machine.

Driver To tighten screws. Service


To remove the hinge of the cover.

Tweezers To unplug the pin connector of the fuser Service


unit.
To remove the E-ring.
Soft cloth To clean the rollers Service
To clean the frame and scan glass

Black soft cloth To cover the OPC drum Service

Install guide, User guide, When installing the machine. Installation


Admin guide

Software CD When installing the machine. Installation

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 6-1


6. Reference Information

Tool Image Use Remark


Test Chart To check the image quality Service
A4 image, A3 image,
Skew

Spare Kit To fix the unit or parts Service


Screw, E-Ring

Clamp To form the harness Service

Grease To remove the noise by gear. Service


G-8050 : JC8108663A (200g)
SPY272 : JC8108664A (100g)

6-2 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


6. Reference Information

6.2. Glossary

The following glossary helps you get familiar with the product by understanding the terminologies commonly used with
printing as well as mentioned in this users guide and service manual.

802.11 is a set of standards for wireless local area network (WLAN) communication, developed by
802.11
the IEEE LAN/MAN Standards Committee (IEEE 802).
802.11b/g/n can share same hardware and use the 2.4 GHz band. 802.11b supports bandwidth up to 11
802.11b/g/n Mbps, 802.11n supports bandwidth up to 150 Mbps. 802.11b/g/n devices may occasionally suffer
interference from microwave ovens, cordless telephones, and Bluetooth devices.
Access Point or Wireless Access Point (AP or WAP) is a device that connects wireless communication
Access point devices together on wireless local area networks (WLAN), and acts as a central transmitter and
receiver of WLAN radio signals.
An Automatic Document Feeder (ADF) is a scanning unit that will automatically feed an original
ADF
sheet of paper so that the machine can scan some amount of the paper at once.
AppleTalk is a proprietary suite of protocols developed by Apple, Inc for computer networking. It
AppleTalk was included in the original Macintosh (1984) and is now deprecated by Apple in favor of TCP/IP
networking.
A computer graphics term describing the number of bits used to represent the color of a single pixel in
a bitmapped image. Higher color depth gives a broader range of distinct colors. As the number of bits
BIT Depth
increases, the number of possible colors becomes impractically large for a color map. 1-bit color is
commonly called as monochrome or black and white.
A bitmapped graphics format used internally by the Microsoft Windows graphics subsystem (GDI),
BMP
and used commonly as a simple graphics file format on that platform.
Bootstrap Protocol. A network protocol used by a network client to obtain its IP address automatically.
This is usually done in the bootstrap process of computers or operating systems running on them. The
BOOTP
BOOTP servers assign the IP address from a pool of addresses to each client. BOOTP enables 'diskless
workstation' computers to obtain an IP address prior to loading any advanced operating system.
Charge Coupled Device (CCD) is a hardware which enables the scan job. CCD Locking mechanism is
CCD
also used to hold the CCD module to prevent any damage when you move the machine.
Collation is a process of printing a multiple-copy job in sets. When collation is selected, the device
Collation
prints an entire set before printing additional copies.
A control panel is a flat, typically vertical, area where control or monitoring instruments are displayed.
Control Panel
They are typically found in front of the machine.
It is the printing term used for a toner usage measurement on printing. For example, 5% coverage
means that an A4 sided paper has about 5% image or text on it. So, if the paper or original has
Coverage
complicated images or lots of text on it, the coverage will be higher and at the same time, a toner
usage will be as much as the coverage.
Comma Separated Values (CSV). A type of file format, CSV is used to exchange data between
CSV disparate applications. The file format, as it is used in Microsoft Excel, has become a de facto standard
throughout the industry, even among non-Microsoft platforms.
A Duplex Automatic Document Feeder (DADF) is a scanning unit that will automatically feed and
DADF
turn over an original sheet of paper so that the machine can scan on both sides of the paper.
Default The value or setting that is in effect when taking a printer out of its box state, reset, or initialized.
A Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) is a client-server networking protocol. A DHCP
server provides configuration parameters specific to the DHCP client host requesting, generally,
DHCP
information required by the client host to participate on an IP network. DHCP also provides a
mechanism for allocation of IP addresses to client hosts.
Dual Inline Memory Module (DIMM), a small circuit board that holds memory. DIMM stores all
DIMM
the data within the machine like printing data, received fax data.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 6-3


6. Reference Information

The Digital Living Network Alliance (DLNA) is a standard that allows devices on a home network to
DLNA
share information with each other across the network.
The Domain Name Server (DNS) is a system that stores information associated with domain names in
DNS
a distributed database on networks, such as the Internet.
A dot matrix printer refers to a type of computer printer with a print head that runs back and forth
Dot Matrix Printer on the page and prints by impact, striking an ink-soaked cloth ribbon against the paper, much like a
typewriter.
Dots Per Inch (DPI) is a measurement of resolution that is used for scanning and printing. Generally,
DPI
higher DPI results in a higher resolution, more visible detail in the image, and a larger file size.
Distinctive Ring Pattern Detection. Distinctive Ring is a telephone company service which enables a
DRPD
user to use a single telephone line to answer several different telephone numbers.
A mechanism that will automatically turn over a sheet of paper so that the machine can print (or
Duplex scan) on both sides of the paper. A printer equipped with a Duplex Unit can print on both sides of
paper during one print cycle.
Duty cycle is the page quantity which does not affect printer performance for a month. Generally the
printer has the lifespan limitation such as pages per year. The lifespan means the average capacity
Duty Cycle
of print-outs, usually within the warranty period. For example, if the duty cycle is 48,000 pages per
month assuming 20 working days, a printer limits 2,400 pages a day.
Error Correction Mode (ECM) is an optional transmission mode built into Class 1 fax machines
ECM or fax modems. It automatically detects and corrects errors in the fax transmission process that
are sometimes caused by telephone line noise.
Emulation is a technique of one machine obtaining the same results as another. An emulator
duplicates the functions of one system with a different system, so that the second system behaves like
Emulation the first system. Emulation focuses on exact reproduction of external behavior, which is in contrast
to simulation, which concerns an abstract model of the system being simulated, often considering
its internal state.
Ethernet is a frame-based computer networking technology for local area networks (LANs). It defines
wiring and signaling for the physical layer, and frame formats and protocols for the media access
Ethernet
control (MAC)/data link layer of the OSI model. Ethernet is mostly standardized as IEEE 802.3. It
has become the most widespread LAN technology in use during the 1990s to the present.
A suite of protocols developed by Apple Computer for computer networking. It was included in the
EtherTalk
original Macintosh (1984) and is now deprecated by Apple in favor of TCP/IP networking.
Foreign Device Interface (FDI) is a card installed inside the machine to allow a third party device
FDI such as a coin operated device or a card reader. Those devices allow the pay-for-print service
on your machine.
A File Transfer Protocol (FTP) is a commonly used protocol for exchanging files over any network
FTP
that supports the TCP/IP protocol (such as the Internet or an intranet).
The part of a laser printer that fuses the toner onto the print media. It consists of a heat roller and
a pressure roller. After toner is transferred onto the paper, the fuser unit applies heat and pressure
Fuser Unit
to ensure that the toner stays on the paper permanently, which is why paper is warm when it comes
out of a laser printer.
A connection between computer networks, or between a computer network and a telephone line. It is
Gateway
very popular, as it is a computer or a network that allows access to another computer or network.
A shades of gray that represent light and dark portions of an image when color images are converted
Grayscale
to grayscale; colors are represented by various shades of gray.
An image type that simulates grayscale by varying the number of dots. Highly colored areas consist of
Halftone
a large number of dots, while lighter areas consist of a smaller number of dots.
Hard Disk Drive (HDD), commonly referred to as a hard drive or hard disk, is a non-volatile storage
HDD
device which stores digitally-encoded data on rapidly rotating platters with magnetic surfaces.

6-4 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


6. Reference Information

The Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers (IEEE) is an international non-profit, professional
IEEE
organization for the advancement of technology related to electricity.
The 1284 parallel port standard was developed by the Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers
IEEE 1284 (IEEE). The term "1284-B" refers to a specific connector type on the end of the parallel cable that
attaches to the peripheral (for example, a printer).
A private network that uses Internet Protocols, network connectivity, and possibly the public
Intranet telecommunication system to securely share part of an organization's information or operations with
its employees. Sometimes the term refers only to the most visible service, the internal website.
An Internet Protocol (IP) address is a unique number that devices use in order to identify and
IP address
communicate with each other on a network utilizing the Internet Protocol standard.
The Images Per Minute (IPM) is a way of measuring the speed of a printer. An IPM rate indicates the
IPM
number of single-sided sheets a printer can complete within one minute.
The Internet Printing Protocol (IPP) defines a standard protocol for printing as well as managing print
jobs, media size, resolution, and so forth. IPP can be used locally or over the Internet to hundreds
IPP
of printers, and also supports access control, authentication, and encryption, making it a much more
capable and secure printing solution than older ones.
IPX/SPX stands for Internet Packet Exchange/Sequenced Packet Exchange. It is a networking
protocol used by the Novell NetWare operating systems. IPX and SPX both provide connection
IPX/SPX services similar to TCP/IP, with the IPX protocol having similarities to IP, and SPX having similarities
to TCP. IPX/SPX was primarily designed for local area networks (LANs), and is a very efficient
protocol for this purpose (typically its performance exceeds that of TCP/IP on a LAN).
The International Organization for Standardization (ISO) is an international standard-setting body
ISO composed of representatives from national standards bodies. It produces world-wide industrial and
commercial standards.
The International Telecommunication Union is an international organization established to standardize
and regulate international radio and telecommunications. Its main tasks include standardization,
ITU-T
allocation of the radio spectrum, and organizing interconnection arrangements between different
countries to allow international phone calls. A -T out of ITU-T indicates telecommunication.
ITU-T No. 1 chart Standardized test chart published by ITU-T for document facsimile transmissions.
Joint Bi-level Image Experts Group (JBIG) is an image compression standard with no loss of accuracy
JBIG or quality, which was designed for compression of binary images, particularly for faxes, but can
also be used on other images.
Joint Photographic Experts Group (JPEG) is a most commonly used standard method of lossy
JPEG compression for photographic images. It is the format used for storing and transmitting photographs
on the World Wide Web.
The Lightweight Directory Access Protocol (LDAP) is a networking protocol for querying and
LDAP
modifying directory services running over TCP/IP.
LED A Light-Emitting Diode (LED) is a semiconductor device that indicates the status of a machine.
Media Access Control (MAC) address is a unique identifier associated with a network adapter. MAC
address is a unique 48-bit identifier usually written as 12 hexadecimal characters grouped in pairs (e.
MAC address
g., 00-00-0c-34-11-4e). This address is usually hard-coded into a Network Interface Card (NIC) by its
manufacturer, and used as an aid for routers trying to locate machines on large networks.
Multi Function Peripheral (MFP) is an office machine that includes the following functionality in one
MFP
physical body, so as to have a printer, a copier, a fax, a scanner and etc.
Modified Huffman (MH) is a compression method for decreasing the amount of data that needs to be
transmitted between the fax machines to transfer the image recommended by ITU-T T.4. MH is a
MH
codebook-based run-length encoding scheme optimized to efficiently compress white space. As most
faxes consist mostly of white space, this minimizes the transmission time of most faxes.
MMR Modified Modified READ (MMR) is a compression method recommended by ITU-T T.6.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 6-5


6. Reference Information

A device that modulates a carrier signal to encode digital information, and also demodulates such a
Modem
carrier signal to decode transmitted information.
Modified Read (MR) is a compression method recommended by ITUT T.4. MR encodes the first
MR scanned line using MH. The next line is compared to the first, the differences determined, and then the
differences are encoded and transmitted.
A network operating system developed by Novell, Inc. It initially used cooperative multitasking to
NetWare run various services on a PC, and the network protocols were based on the archetypal Xerox XNS
stack. Today NetWare supports TCP/IP as well as IPX/SPX.
Organic Photo Conductor (OPC) is a mechanism that makes a virtual image for print using a laser
beam emitted from a laser printer, and it is usually green or rust colored and has a cylinder shape.
OPC An imaging unit containing a drum slowly wears the drum surface by its usage in the printer, and
it should be replaced appropriately since it gets worn from contact with the cartridge development
brush, cleaning mechanism, and paper.
The first example of something, such as a document, photograph or text, etc, which is copied,
Originals reproduced or translated to produce others, but which is not itself copied or derived from something
else.
Open Systems Interconnection (OSI) is a model developed by the International Organization for
Standardization (ISO) for communications. OSI offers a standard, modular approach to network
OSI design that divides the required set of complex functions into manageable, self-contained, functional
layers. The layers are, from top to bottom, Application, Presentation, Session, Transport, Network,
Data Link and Physical.
A private automatic branch exchange (PABX) is an automatic telephone switching system within a
PABX
private enterprise.
Printer Command Language (PCL) is a Page Description Language (PDL) developed by HP as a
PCL printer protocol and has become an industry standard. Originally developed for early inkjet printers,
PCL has been released in varying levels for thermal, dot matrix printer, and laser printers.
Portable Document Format (PDF) is a proprietary file format developed by Adobe Systems for
PDF
representing two dimensional documents in a device independent and resolution independent format.
PostScript (PS) is a page description language and programming language used primarily in the
PostScript(PS)
electronic and desktop publishing areas. - that is run in an interpreter to generate an image.
Printer Driver A program used to send commands and transfer data from the computer to the printer.
The media like paper, envelopes, labels, and transparencies which can be used in a printer, a scanner, a
Print Media
fax or, a copier.
Pages Per Minute (PPM) is a method of measurement for determining how fast a printer works,
PPM
meaning the number of pages a printer can produce in one minute.
An interface for a device driver, this allows software to interact with the device driver using standard
PRN file
input/output system calls, which simplifies many tasks.
A convention or standard that controls or enables the connection, communication, and data transfer
Protocol
between two computing endpoints.
The Public-Switched Telephone Network (PSTN) is the network of the world's public circuit-switched
PSTN
telephone networks which, on industrial premises, is usually routed through the switchboard.
Remote Authentication Dial In User Service (RADIUS) is a protocol for remote user authentication
and accounting. RADIUS enables centralized management of authentication data such as usernames
RADIUS
and passwords using an AAA (authentication, authorization, and accounting) concept to manage
network access.
The sharpness of an image, measured in Dots Per Inch (DPI). The higher the dpi, the greater the
Resolution
resolution.
Server Message Block (SMB) is a network protocol mainly applied to share files, printers, serial ports,
SMB and miscellaneous communications between nodes on a network. It also provides an authenticated
Interprocess communication mechanism.

6-6 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


6. Reference Information

Simple Mail Transfer Protocol (SMTP) is the standard for e-mail transmissions across the Internet.
SMTP is a relatively simple, text based protocol, where one or more recipients of a message are
SMTP
specified, and then the message text is transferred. It is a client server protocol, where the client
transmits an email message to the server.
Service Set Identifier (SSID) is a name of a wireless local area network (WLAN). All wireless devices
SSID in a WLAN use the same SSID in order to communicate with each other. The SSIDs are case-sensitive
and have a maximum length of 32 characters.
The subnet mask is used in conjunction with the network address to determine which part of the
Subnet Mask
address is the network address and which part is the host address.
The Transmission Control Protocol (TCP) and the Internet Protocol (IP); the set of communications
TCP/IP
protocols that implement the protocol stack on which the Internet and most commercial networks run.
Transmission Confirmation Report (TCR) provides details of each transmission such as job status,
TCR transmission result and number of pages sent. This report can be set to print after each job or only
after failed transmissions.
Tagged Image File Format (TIFF) is a variable-resolution bitmapped image format. TIFF describes
image data that typically come from scanners. TIFF images make use of tags, keywords defining the
TIFF
characteristics of the image that is included in the file. This flexible and platform-independent format
can be used for pictures that have been made by various image processing applications.
A kind of bottle or container used in a machine like a printer which contains toner. Toner is a powder
used in laser printers and photocopiers, which forms the text and images on the printed paper. Toner
Toner Cartridge
can be fused by a combination of heat/pressure from the fuser, causing it to bind to the fibers in
the paper.
An industry standard for scanners and software. By using a TWAINcompliant scanner with a
TWAIN TWAIN-compliant program, a scan can be initiated from within the program. It is an image capture
API for Microsoft Windows and Apple Macintosh operating systems.
Uniform Naming Convention (UNC) is a standard way to access network shares in Window NT and
UNC Path other Microsoft products. The format of a UNC path is: \\<servername>\<sharename>\<Additional
directory>
Uniform Resource Locator (URL) is the global address of documents and resources on the Internet.
URL The first part of the address indicates what protocol to use, the second part specifies the IP address or
the domain name where the resource is located.
Universal Serial Bus (USB) is a standard that was developed by the USB Implementers Forum, Inc., to
USB connect computers and peripherals. Unlike the parallel port, USB is designed to concurrently connect
a single computer USB port to multiple peripherals.
A watermark is a recognizable image or pattern in paper that appears lighter when viewed by
transmitted light. Watermarks were first introduced in Bologna, Italy in 1282; they have been used by
Watermark
papermakers to identify their product, and also on postage stamps, currency, and other government
documents to discourage counterfeiting.
Wired Equivalent Privacy (WEP) is a security protocol specified in IEEE 802.11 to provide the same
WEP level of security as that of a wired LAN. WEP provides security by encrypting data over radio so that
it is protected as it is transmitted from one end point to another.
Windows Imaging Architecture (WIA) is an imaging architecture that is originally introduced in
WIA Windows Me and Windows XP. A scan can be initiated from within these operating systems by
using a WIAcompliant scanner.
Wi-Fi Protected Access (WPA) is a class of systems to secure wireless (Wi-Fi) computer networks,
WPA
which was created to improve upon the security features of WEP.
WPA-PSK (WPA Pre-Shared Key) is special mode of WPA for small business or home users. A
shared key, or password, is configured in the wireless access point (WAP) and any wireless laptop or
WPA-PSK
desktop devices. WPA-PSK generates a unique key for each session between a wireless client and the
associated WAP for more advanced security.

Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 6-7


6. Reference Information

The Wi-Fi Protected Setup (WPS) is a standard for establishing a wireless home network. If your
WPS wireless access point supports WPS, you can configure the wireless network connection easily
without a computer.
XML Paper Specification (XPS) is a specification for a Page Description Language (PDL) and a new
document format, which has benefits for portable document and electronic document, developed
XPS
by Microsoft. It is an XML-based specification, based on a new print path and a vector-based
device-independent document format.

6-8 Copyright 1995-2012 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


Exploded Views and Parts List

1. Main
Exploded View

Parts List
No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
1 SCX-8128NA/SEE 1 JC90-01118A EXIT; CLX-9201 SA
2 SCX-8128NA/SEE 1 JC91-01050A FUSER; SCX-8128NA,SEC, SA
WORLD,220V
3 SCX-8128NA/SEE 1 JC93-00439A FRAME-MAIN ENGINE; SCX-8128NA, SNA
SEC, WORLD
4 SCX-8128NA/SEE 1 JC95-01508A COVER-SIDE MONO; CLX-9201 SA
5 SCX-8128NA/SEE 1 JC96-06214A CARTRIDGE-WTB; SCX-8128NA, SEC, SNA
WORLD
6 SCX-8128NA/SEE 1 JC95-01495A COVER; SCX-8128NA, WORLD, SEC SNA
7 SCX-8128NA/SEE 1 JC97-04006B OPE; CLX-9201, WORLD, SEC SNA
8 SCX-8128NA/SEE 1 JC97-04020A PLATEN FR HR; CLX-9201, SCANNER SA
9 SCX-8128NA/SEE 1 JC97-03989A DADF; CLX-9201, SEC SA

Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 1


Exploded Views and Parts List

No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
10 SCX-8128NA/SEE 1 JC97-04017A LSU; SCX-8123ND, SEC, single, A3, SA
600, Single Beam, 780nm single, CW,
Straight
11 JC98-01889A 2 JC44-00182A HVPS; 24V,21.6V~27.6V, MAX 8KV, SA
MAX-8KV,600
12 JC98-01889A 2 JC44-00100C SMPS-V2; CLX-9201, PSPN SNA
TYPE5-V2, AC-DC, 275W, 220V-240V,
50/60Hz,200*120*40, 85%,+5.1V /
+24V,+5.1V; 7A / +24V; 10A,O,O,O,O
13 JC98-01889A 2 JC44-00211A FDB-POLARIS / EVERGREEN_V2; SNA
CLX-9201, POLARIS / EVERGREEN
FDB-V2, AC/AC(PC)
14 JC93-00500A 3 JC31-00160A FAN-TYPE 5; Type5, 24,170mA, SA
4.0mmH20, 0.433m^3/mi
15 JC98-01889A 2 JC61-04861A HOLDER-FILTER OZONE; SNA
SCX-8128NA, HIPS, 98,79, Split
Brown Black(G32690), FG-1790
16 JC98-01889A 2 JC92-02452A PBA-MAIN; SCX-8128,SEC, FR-4, SA
6Layer
17 JC98-01889A 2 JC92-02439A PBA-FAX JOINT; CLX-9201, SEC, SA
CEM-3, 2Layer

2 Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


Exploded Views and Parts List

2. EXIT
Exploded View

Parts List
No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
0 SCX-8128NA/SEE 1 JC90-01118A EXIT; CLX-9201 SA
1 JC90-01118A 2 6003-000196 SCREW-TAPTYPE; CLX-9350, SA
POM,1.0, 16,18.39
2 JC90-01118A 2 JC61-00423A BUSH-6_D; CLX-9350, SUM24L, 187,3 SA
3 JC90-01118A 2 JC61-04690A BRACKET-REAR EXIT; CLX-9201 SNA
4 JC90-01118A 2 0604-001393 PHOTO-INTERRUPTER; CLX-9201, SA
SECC, T1.0,49, 52
5 JC90-01118A 2 JC67-00563A BRUSH-EXIT; CLX-9350, PC, HAZE SNA
GRAY
6 JC90-01118A 2 JC66-02163A GEAR-EXIT; CLX-9201,SUS FIBER, SA
347.5, 15.9
7 JC90-01118A 2 6107-002654 SPRING-TS; DACS-2N, 6.2*2.8, SC
Nylon66

Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 3


Exploded Views and Parts List

No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
8 JC90-01118A 2 JC66-02217A ACTUATOR-F_D FULL EXIT; SA
CLX-9201
9 JC90-01118A 2 JC66-02218A LEVER-ACTURATOR F_D FULL; SA
CLX-9201
10 JC90-01118A 2 JC66-02278A LEVER-ACT FULL EXIT; CLX-9210, SA
PET, 0.188, 8.8, 18.5
11 JC90-01118A 2 JC66-02423A SHAFT-ACTUATOR F_D FULL SNA
EXIT; CLX-9201, UL10272,3p,
175mm,BLK/GREY, AWG26,173977-3,
UL 10272, BOARD TO BOARD WIRE
12 JC90-01118A 2 JC90-01133A EXIT-GUIDE LOWER; SUS304, PI0.45, SA
ID6.5, OD7.4, RIGHT, 115
13 JC90-01118A 2 JC90-01132A EXIT-GUIDE UPPER; CLX-9350, PC, SA
Black
14 JC90-01118A 2 6502-001131 CABLE CLAMP; ML-9400W,NTR SNA

4 Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


Exploded Views and Parts List

3. CASSETTE-1ST
Exploded View

Parts List
No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
0 SCX-8128NA/SEE 1 JC90-01140A CASSETTE-1ST; CLX-9201, SEC SA
1 JC90-01140A 2 JC61-04712A FRAME-CASSETTE 1ST; CLX-9201, SNA
POM,1,60
2 JC90-01140A 2 JC64-00715A LOCKER-CASSETTE 1ST; CLX-9350, SNA
POM, OD10, L16.5, GUIDE
3 JC90-01140A 2 6107-001761 SPRING-ES; HWH,+,M3, L8, SA
ZPC(WHT), SWRCH18A ,C TYPE
4 JC90-01140A 2 JC61-04886A HOLDER-LOCKER; CLX-9201, SNA
Flocking, BLK, 0.5, 44,13
5 JC90-01140A 2 6003-000196 SCREW-TAPTYPE; CLX-9201, SEC SA
6 JC90-01140A 2 JC90-01129A CASSETTE-COVER; CLX-9201, POM, SA
BLACK, 73.5X13X43.5

Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 5


Exploded Views and Parts List

No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
7 JC90-01140A 2 JC90-01130A CASSETTE-GUIDE FRONT; CLX-9201, SA
ABS, 3,21.5, 232, HF-0660i, BLACK,
LINK
8 JC90-01140A 2 JC90-01131A CASSETTE-GUIDE REAR; CLX-9201, SA
SEC
9 JC90-01140A 2 JC66-01020A GEAR-M_PINION 24; PWH,+,2, M3, SA
L8, ZPC(BLK), SWRCH18A
10 JC90-01140A 2 6002-000440 SCREW-TAPPING; PWH,+,-,B, M3, L6, SNA
ZPC(WHT), SWRCH18A,-
11 JC90-01140A 2 JC90-01128A CASSETTE-BRACKET LIFT; CLP-500, SA
Fe+Cu+Zn-Slearate
12 JC90-01140A 2 JC66-03285A SHAFT-LIFTING CST; CLX-9201, SNA
SECC, 1T, 360.2, 360.1
13 JC90-01140A 2 JC61-00699A BUSH-D6/L4; CLX-9201, SEC SA
14 JC90-01140A 2 JC66-03278A GEAR-LIFTING CST; SCX-6345N/XRX, SNA
POM, 1,24, NTR, 26
15 JC90-01140A 2 6044-000125 RING-E; SWP B,PI0.55, L27.9, ID4.35, SA
OD4.55
16 JC90-01140A 2 JC61-03206A PLATE-LEVER; CLX-9201, SEC SNA
17 JC90-01140A 2 6009-001664 SCREW-HEX; CLX-9201, EPE, 60, 360, SNA
60, NATURE, SEC
18 JC90-01140A 2 JC61-04718A GUIDE-LEFT; CLX-9201, HIPS, SNA
G72797, 2.5, 419, 516, HR-1360T
19 JC90-01140A 2 JC64-00704A INDICATOR-SIZE REAR; CLX-9201, SNA
SEC
20 JC90-01140A 2 JC66-03202A LEVER-LINK SIZE 1ST; SNA
CLX-9201,HIPS, 62.2,30, ICE-GREEN,
PAPER
21 JC90-01140A 2 6003-000264 SCREW-TAPTYPE; ID4, OD9, T0.6, SNA
STSC
22 JC90-01140A 2 JC64-00703A INDICATOR-SIZE SIDE; PWH,+,B, M3, SNA
L10, NI PLT, SWRCH18A
23 JC90-01140A 2 JC61-04767A PLATE-KNOCK UP; CLX-9350, SECC, SNA
1.6T, 73,60
24 JC90-01140A 2 JC62-00946A SEAL-PAD CST; CLX-9201, ABS, SNA
G72797, 138X46X49, HF-0660i
25 JC90-01140A 2 JC61-03331A ROLLER-IDLE CST; CLX-9201, SA
SUM22, 229,6

6 Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


Exploded Views and Parts List

4. CASSETTE-2ND
Exploded View

Parts List
No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
0 SCX-8128NA/SEE 1 JC90-01141A CASSETTE-2ND; CLX-9201,SEC SA
1 JC90-01141A 2 JC61-04713A FRAME-CASSETTE 2ND; SNA
PWH,+,B,M3,L10,NI PLT,SWRCH18A
2 JC90-01141A 2 JC64-00716A LOCKER-CASSETTE 2ND; PWH,+,2, SNA
M3, L8, ZPC(BLK), SWRCH18A
3 JC90-01141A 2 6107-001761 SPRING-ES; CLX-9201, ABS, 3, 21.5, SA
280, HF-0660i, BLACK, LINK
4 JC90-01141A 2 JC61-04886A HOLDER-LOCKER; CLX-9201, SNA
Flocking, BLK,0.5, 44, 13
5 JC90-01141A 2 6003-000196 SCREW-TAPTYPE; CLX-9201, SEC SA
6 JC90-01141A 2 JC90-01129A CASSETTE-COVER; CLX-9350, POM, SA
OD10, L16.5, GUIDE
7 JC90-01141A 2 JC90-01130A CASSETTE-GUIDE FRONT; CLX-9201, SA
HIPS, 62.2, 30, ICE-GREEN,PAPER

Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 7


Exploded Views and Parts List

No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
8 JC90-01141A 2 JC90-01131A CASSETTE-GUIDE REAR; CLX-9201, SA
SEC
9 JC90-01141A 2 JC66-01020A GEAR-M_PINION 24; CLX-9201, POM, SA
BLACK, 120. 5X13X43.5
10 JC90-01141A 2 6002-000440 SCREW-TAPPING; PWH,+,-,B, M3, L6, SNA
ZPC(WHT), SWRCH18A,-
11 JC90-01141A 2 JC90-01128A CASSETTE-BRACKET LIFT; CLP-500, SA
Fe+Cu+Zn-Slearate
12 JC90-01141A 2 JC66-03285A SHAFT-LIFTING CST; CLX-9201, SNA
SECC, 1T, 360.2, 360.1
13 JC90-01141A 2 JC61-00699A BUSH-D6/L4; CLX-9350, 45, 140 SA
14 JC90-01141A 2 JC66-03278A GEAR-LIFTING CST; SCX-6345N/XRX, SNA
POM,1,24, NTR, 26
15 JC90-01141A 2 6044-000125 RING-E; SWP B,PI0.55, L27.9, ID4.35, SA
OD4.55
16 JC90-01141A 2 JC61-03206A PLATE-LEVER; CLX-9201, SEC SNA
17 JC90-01141A 2 6009-001664 SCREW-HEX; CLX-9201, EPE, 60, 360, SNA
60, NATURE, SEC
18 JC90-01141A 2 JC61-04718A GUIDE-LEFT; CLX-9201, POM, 1,60 SNA
19 JC90-01141A 2 JC64-00704A INDICATOR-SIZE REAR; CLX-9201, SNA
SEC
20 JC90-01141A 2 JC66-03201A LEVER-LINK SIZE 2ND; HWH,+, M3, SNA
L8, ZPC(WHT), SWRCH18A, C TYPE
21 JC90-01141A 2 6003-000264 SCREW-TAPTYPE; ID4,OD9,T0.6, SNA
STSC
22 JC90-01141A 2 JC64-00703A INDICATOR-SIZE SIDE; CLX-9201, SNA
HIPS, G72797, 464, 516, HR-1360T
23 JC90-01141A 2 JC61-04767A PLATE-KNOCK UP; CLX-9350, SECC, SNA
1.6T, 73,60
24 JC90-01141A 2 JC62-00946A SEAL-PAD CST; CLX-9201, ABS, SNA
G72797, 138X46X49, HF-0660i
25 JC90-01141A 2 JC61-03331A ROLLER-IDLE CST; CLX-9201, SA
SUM22, 229,6

8 Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


Exploded Views and Parts List

5. FUSER
Exploded View

Parts List
No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
0 SCX-8128NA/SEE 1 JC91-01050A FUSER; SCX-8128NA, SEC, WORLD, SA
220V
1 JC91-01050A 2 JC66-03256A ROLLER-PRESSURE; SWP B, CD0.45, SA
L18.8, ID5.9, OD6.8
2 JC91-01050A 2 JC66-03257A ROLLER-HEAT; SCX-8128ND, SA
PET+GF, 1.6, 75.5, 100.9
3 JC91-01050A 2 6601-001479 BEARING-BALL; SCX-8128NA, SA
STAINLESS-STS304, T0.8, L304
4 JC91-01050A 2 6601-002415 BEARING-BALL; SCX-8128NA, SEC, SNA
EXP
5 JC91-01050A 2 JC66-03131A GEAR-DRIVE; HWH,+, M3,L8, SA
ZPC(WHT), SWRCH18A, C TYPE
6 JC91-01050A 2 6107-003005 SPRING-ETC; SCX-8128NA, SEC,EXP SA
7 JC91-01050A 2 4713-001633 LAMP-HALOGEN; SWP B,CD1.2, L44, SA
OD7.3

Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 9


Exploded Views and Parts List

No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
8 JC91-01050A 2 JC61-04515A BRACKET-BEARING; SCX-8128ND, SA
PET+GF, 2.0, 74.9, 75.6
9 JC91-01050A 2 JC61-04521A BRACKET-LAMP FRONT; SA
SCX-8128NA, SEC, WORLD, 220V
10 JC91-01050A 2 JC61-04522A BRACKET-LAMP REAR; CLP-350N, SA
SAMSUNG, PET,0.05, 17,65, YEL,
COMMON, 220V
11 JC91-01050A 2 6107-003003 SPRING-CS; 230V, 1300W, 13*9.8*380.9 SA
12 JC91-01050A 2 JC63-03277A GROUND-BIAS PR; ID4,OD9, T0.6, SA
STSC
13 JC91-01050A 2 JC61-04519A BRACKET-SPRING REAR; SA
SCX-8123ND, STKM+SPONGE,
28.5, BLACK, RUBBER 6t
14 JC91-01050A 2 JC61-04518A BRACKET-SPRING FRONT; SA
SCX-8128NA, EGI-SECC, T1.2,
W22.7, L64
15 JC91-01050A 2 6107-003004 SPRING-ES; SUS304, CD1.0 SA
16 JC91-01050A 2 JC61-04520A BRACKET-INPUT PR; SCX-8128NA, SA
Polyester Needle Felt, 1, W17.7, L300,
YELLOW
17 JC91-01050A 2 JC66-03103A SHAFT-CAM; SCX-8123ND, POM, 1.0, SA
Z16, OD18.40
18 JC91-01050A 2 JC66-03178A CAM-REAR; SCX-8123ND, SA
AL3304-H34, 30, GRAY
19 JC91-01050A 2 JC66-03132A GEAR-IDLE_M; PWH,+,B,M3, L10, NI SA
PLT, SWRCH18A
20 JC91-01050A 2 JC61-04533A HOLDER-WHEEL POSITION; SA
SCX-8128ND, POM, W17, D15.4, H6.4,
WHITE
21 JC91-01050A 2 JC61-00423A BUSH-6_D; SCX-8128NA, SEC, EXP SA
22 JC91-01050A 2 JC61-01958A BUSH-HR; SCX-8128NA,EGI-SECC, SA
T1.2, W28.6, L63.78
23 JC91-01050A 2 JC63-03316A COVER-SIDE REAR; ML-9400W, SA
bearing
24 JC91-01050A 2 JC63-03317A COVER-SIDE FRONT; SA
L-1680HHMTRLY13 ,ID8, OD16,
688ZZ
25 JC91-01050A 2 JC91-01051A FUSER-FRAME LOWER; SA
SCX-8128NA, SUS, 0.2, W21.7,
L15.1, GROUND
26 JC91-01050A 2 JC91-01052A FUSER-BRACKET PR; 6705ZZ, ID25.0, SA
OD32.0, L4, CWB
27 JC91-01050A 2 JC91-01053A FUSER-OUTPUT HR; SCX-8128NA, SA
STAINLESS-STS304, T0.5, W22.25,
L43.3
28 JC91-01050A 2 JC91-01054A FUSER-FRAME UPPER; SCX-8128NA, SA
SEC, EXP

10 Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


Exploded Views and Parts List

No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
29 JC91-01050A 2 JC91-01062A FUSER-OUTPUT PR; SCX-8128ND, SA
PC,T1.5, W17.35, BLACK
30 JC91-01050A 2 JC63-03275A FELT-BOTTOM; SCX-8128NA, SEC, SA
EXP

Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 11


Exploded Views and Parts List

6. FRAME-MAIN ENGINE
Exploded View

Parts List
No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
1 JC93-00439A 2 JC93-00078B FRAME-REGI HOLDER DUST; SA
SCX-8040, SEC, WORLD
2 JC93-00436A 3 JC93-00442A DRIVE-PICKUP; SCX-8128NA, SEC SA
3 JC93-00436A 3 JC93-00448A DRIVE MAIN; CLX-9201NA, SEC SA
3-1 JC93-00448A 4 JC31-00123B MOTOR BLDC; BH,+,S,M4, SA
L6,ZPC(WHT), SWRCH18A
3-2 JC93-00448A 4 JC31-00123A MOTOR BLDC; SCX-8128NA, SEC SA
3-3 JC93-00448A 4 JC93-00724A DRIVE-MAIN SUB MONO; 2000rpm, SA
1200gfcm, 24V, 2.8A, 1500gfcm
4 JC93-00436A 3 JC93-00449A DRIVE-M FUSER EXIT; SCX-8128NA, SA
SEC
5 JC93-00436A 3 JC93-00450A DRIVE-M TONER SUPPLY; SA
SCX-8128NA, SEC
6 JC93-00436A 3 JC93-00451A DRIVE-DUCT; SCX-8128NA, SEC SA
7 JC93-00439A 2 JC93-00508A FRAME-MAIN REGI; CLX-9201 SA
8 JC93-00439A 2 JC93-00511A FRAME MAIN-PICKUP 1ST; CLX-9201, SA
SEC

12 Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


Exploded Views and Parts List

No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
9 JC93-00439A 2 JC93-00512A FRAME MAIN-PICKUP 2ND; SA
CLX-9201, SEC
10 JC93-00439A 2 JC93-00684A FRAME-MAIN; SCX-8128, SEC, SA
WORLD

Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 13


Exploded Views and Parts List

6.1. DRIVE FUSER-EXIT

Exploded View

Parts List
No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
0 JC93-00436A 3 JC93-00449A DRIVE-M FUSER EXIT; SCX-8128NA, SA
SEC
1 JC93-00449A 4 JC61-04512A BRACKET-M DRIVE FUSER EXIT; SA
ML-2150, NYLON, 1,25,8, NTR,27
2 JC93-00449A 4 JC66-03108A GEAR-RDCN EXIT; POLYMIDE, ID6, SA
OD13.5, T0.5, BLK
3 JC93-00449A 4 JC66-03141A GEAR-M FUSER ONE WAY; SA
SCX-8128NA, SEC
4 JC93-00449A 4 JC66-00340A GEAR-HUB CLUTCH; BH,+,-,S, M3, SA
L6, ZPC(WHT), SWRCH18A,-
5 JC93-00449A 4 JC66-00417A GEAR-RDCN FUSER OUT; BH, +, S, SA
M4, L6, ZPC(WHT), SWRCH18A
6 JC93-00449A 4 JC66-03106A GEAR-RDCN FUSER RELEASE; SA
PF262(HS), WHITE

14 Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


Exploded Views and Parts List

No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
7 JC93-00449A 4 JC66-03107A GEAR-FUSER RELEASE; SA
SCX-8128NA, POM, 0.5, 71,
HELICAL(R)
8 JC93-00449A 4 JC31-00123B MOTOR BLDC; SCX-8128NA, SA
EGI-SECC, 1.0T
9 JC93-00449A 4 JC93-00452A DRIVE-MOTOR STEP; ID5.0, OD11.0, SA
T0.6, PASS, STS304

Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 15


Exploded Views and Parts List

6.2. FRAME-MAIN REGI

Exploded View

Parts List
No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
0 JC93-00433A 2 JC93-00508A FRAME-MAIN REGI; CLX-9201 SA
1 JC93-00508A 3 0604-001381 PHOTO-INTERRUPTER; CLX-9201, SA
SECC, T1, 63.5,34
2 JC93-00508A 3 JC66-03302A SHAFT-REGI; CLP-500, SNA
Fe+Cu+Zn-Slearate
3 JC93-00508A 3 JC66-03180A ROLLER-REGI; CLX-9201, UL10272, SNA
3p,75mm, BLK/GRAY, AWG26,
173977-3, UL 10272, BOARD TO
BOARD WIRE
4 JC93-00508A 3 JC66-03293A GEAR-ROLLER REGI; CLX-9201 SNA
5 JC93-00508A 3 6107-001759 SPRING-ES; CLX-9201, SUM22, SA
361.9,14.7, STEEL

16 Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


Exploded Views and Parts List

6.3. FRAME MAIN PICKUP1_2

Exploded View

Parts List
No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
1 JC93-00433A 2 JC93-00511A FRAME MAIN-PICKUP 1ST; CLX-9201, SA
SEC
1-1 JC93-00511A 3 JC63-03342A SHEET-GUIDE PICKUP; CLX-9201 SNA
1-2 JC93-00511A 3 JC61-04721A GUIDE-PICKUP 1ST; CLX-9210, SNA
PET,0.188, 323,25
1-3 JC93-00511A 3 JC61-04723A GUIDE-HARNESS PICKUP; CLX-9201, SNA
SEC
1-4 JC93-00511A 3 JC93-00510A FRAME MAIN-PICKUP; SA
CLX-9201, ABS, 327,43, HF-0660I,
BLACK(K21441), PAPER
2 JC93-00433A 2 JC93-00512A FRAME MAIN-PICKUP 2ND; SA
CLX-9201, SEC
2-1 JC93-00512A 3 JC61-04735A GUIDE-PICKUP BOTTOM; CLX-9201, SNA
SEC
2-2 JC93-00512A 3 JC61-04717A GUIDE-PICKUP 2ND; CLX-9201, ABS, SNA
54,20, HF-0660I, BLACK(K21441),
GUIDE

Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 17


Exploded Views and Parts List

6.3.1. FRAME MAIN PICKUP

Exploded View

Parts List
No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
0 JC93-00511A 3 JC93-00510A FRAME MAIN-PICKUP; CLX-9201, SA
SEC
1 JC93-00510A 4 6044-000125 RING-E; CLX-9201,SECC, 1.2T, 84, 42 SA
2 JC93-00510A 4 JC61-00699A BUSH-D6/L4; CLX-9201, SEC SA
3 JC93-00510A 4 JC61-04731A BRACKET-PICKUP REAR; CLX-9201, SNA
SEC
4 JC93-00510A 4 JC61-04730A BRACKET-PICKUP FRONT; CLX-9201 SNA
5 JC93-00510A 4 JC66-03281A GEAR-PICKUP; CLX-9201, SNA
STAINLESS-STS303, 225. 3,6,
STEEL
6 JC93-00510A 4 JC66-03304A SHAFT-FORWARD; CLX-9201, SEC SNA
7 JC93-00510A 4 JC93-00503A FRAME MAIN-PICKUP LOWER; SNA
CLX-9201, SECC, 1.2T, 85,52
7-1 JC93-00503A 5 JC66-03200A LEVER-INPUT CST; SUS304, 0.55, 12.1, SNA
4.3, FREE, CLOSED END

18 Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


Exploded Views and Parts List

No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
7-2 JC93-00503A 5 JC61-04732A HOLDER-RETARD; CLX-9201, SEC SNA
7-3 JC93-00503A 5 JC66-03283A SHAFT-RETARD; SCX-6345N/XRX, SNA
POM, T1.5, NTR
7-4 JC93-00503A 5 JC67-00455A COUPLER-TORQUELIMITER; ID4, SNA
OD9, T0.6, STSC
7-5 JC93-00503A 5 JC93-00438A FRAME MAIN-PICKUP BRKT SNA
LOWER; CLX-9201, POM, 9,48, 28.7,
M90-44, BLACK,GUIDE
7-6 JC93-00503A 5 6107-003049 SPRING-CS; CLX-9350, WHITE, SA
350GF*CM
7-7 JC93-00503A 5 JC61-01367A FIXER-M_E RING 4PI; CLX-9201, SA
POM, 23, 97, 24, BLACK, M90-44
8 JC93-00510A 4 JC93-00504A FRAME MAIN-PICKUP UPPER; ID4, SNA
OD9, T0.6, STSC
9 JC93-00510A 4 JC93-00540A FRAME-MAIN PICK UP ROLLER; SA
CLP-500, Fe+Cu+Zn

Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 19


Exploded Views and Parts List

6.3.1.1. FRAME MAIN PICKUP UPPER

Exploded View

Parts List
No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
0 JC93-00510A 4 JC93-00504A FRAME MAIN-PICKUP UPPER; SNA
CLX-9201, SEC
1 JC93-00504A 5 JC93-00437A FRAME MAIN-PICKUP BRKT UPPER; SNA
CLX-9201, SEC
2 JC93-00504A 5 JC66-03284A SHAFT-PICKUP; CLX-PFP100, SUS304, SNA
0.2T, 56, 21.23
3 JC93-00504A 5 JC66-03199A ACTUATOR-EMPTY PICKUP; SNA
SCX-6345N/XRX, POM, T1.8,15mm,
12,WHT
4 JC93-00504A 5 JC66-00977A CLUTCH-P_ONE WAY; CLX-9201, SA
STAINLESS-STS303,129.5,6, STEEL
5 JC93-00504A 5 JC66-00943A GEAR-M_PU JOINT; SUS304, 0.65,17, SA
6.45, RIGHT HAND, CLOSED END

20 Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


Exploded Views and Parts List

No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
6 JC93-00504A 5 JC66-00941A GEAR-M_ONE WAY; CLX-9201, SA
PET,0.125,12,25
7 JC93-00504A 5 JC66-00940A GEAR-M_IDLE PU; CLX-9201, POM, SA
120,46, M90-44, BLACK,PAPER
8 JC93-00504A 5 JC61-04736A GUIDE-PICKUP UPPER; CLX-9201, SNA
POM, 22,73,10, M90-44, BLACK,
ACTUATOR-High Tem
9 JC93-00504A 5 JC61-04722A GUIDE-SLIDE PICKUP; SNA
SCX-6345N/XRX, POM,
0.7,21,WHT,16.1
10 JC93-00504A 5 JC61-04716A GUIDE-SUPPORT PICKUP; SNA
SCX-6345N/XRX, OWC612GXRZ,
0.8N.M,NTR
11 JC93-00504A 5 JC61-04670A BRACKET-GRN PICKUP; SNA
SCX-6345N/XRX, POM,0.7,22,
WHT,16.8
12 JC93-00504A 5 JC61-01288A HOLDER-M_IDLE ONE WAY; SA
DACS-2N, 6.2*2.8, Nylon66
13 JC93-00504A 5 6502-001131 CABLE CLAMP; SCX-6345N/XRX, SNA
POM, 0.7,21,WHT, 16.1
14 JC93-00504A 5 6107-003046 SPRING-CS; CLX-9201, ABS,15, 305,23, SA
HF-0660i, BLACK, PAPER
15 JC93-00504A 5 0604-001393 PHOTO-INTERRUPTER; CLX-9201, SA
SEC

Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 21


Exploded Views and Parts List

6.4. FRAME-MAIN

Exploded View

Parts List
No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
12 JC93-00684A 3 JC93-00477A FRAME MAIN-LEFT CST RAIL; SNA
CLX-9201, POM,1,21
13 JC93-00684A 3 JC93-00478A FRAME MAIN-RIGHT CST SNA
RAIL; SCX-6345N/XRX,
OWC612GXRZ,0.8N.M,NTR
14 JC93-00684A 3 JC93-00484A FRAME MAIN-SUPPORT SCAN SNA
RIGHT; ML-9400W, bearing,
15 JC93-00684A 3 JC61-04864A GUIDE-TONER BOTTLE; CLX-9201, SNA
SEC, WORLD
16 JC93-00684A 3 JC61-04863A GUIDE-OPC; SCX-8128NA, SEC, SNA
WORLD
17 JC93-00684A 3 JC61-04835A PLATE-TOP EXIT MONO; CLX-9201, SNA
HIPS, 46.3, 109.5,61.4, BLACK,
HR-1360T

22 Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


Exploded Views and Parts List

No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
18 JC93-00684A 3 JC61-04834A PLATE-LSU LOWER; CLX-9201, SEC, SNA
WORLD
19 JC93-00684A 3 JC66-03274A WIRE-GUIDE LSU; SCX-8128NA, SNA
ABS,260. 1,15.4, HF-0660i,
BLACK,PATH

Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 23


Exploded Views and Parts List

7. COVER
Exploded View

Parts List
No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
1 JC95-01495A 2 JC95-01492A COVER-FRONT MONO; SCX-8128NA, SA
SECC, T0.6, W536, L649
2 JC95-01495A 2 JC63-03405A COVER-FRONT LOWER; CLX-9201, SA
WORLD, SEC
3 JC95-01495A 2 JC95-01494A COVER-INNER MONO; CLX-9201, SA
HIPS, T2, W103.5, L48.8, G32690,
FG-1790
4 JC95-01495A 2 JC63-03404A COVER-FRONT TOP DECO; SA
SCX-8128NA, HIPS, T2, W95.6,
L444, G32690, FG-1790
5 JC95-01495A 2 JC63-03403A COVER-FRONT TOP; SCX-8128NA, SA
HIPS, T2, W44, L323.5, G32690,
FG-1790

24 Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


Exploded Views and Parts List

No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
6 JC95-01495A 2 JC95-01493A COVER-LEFT MONO; CLX-9201, HIPS, SA
2.5, W550, L96.7, G32690, FG-1790
7 JC95-01495A 2 JC63-03396A COVER-SCAN LEFT; SCX-8128NA, SA
WORLD, SEC
8 JC95-01495A 2 JC95-01502A COVER-SCAN FRONT; CLX-9201, PC, SA
0.38, W13,L13, G32690
9 JC95-01495A 2 JC63-03406A COVER-LEFT UPPER; CLX-9201, SA
WORLD, SEC
10 JC95-01495A 2 JC63-03389A COVER-EXIT REAR; CLX-9201, SA
WORLD, SEC
11 JC95-01495A 2 JC95-01499A COVER-EXIT; SCX-8128NA, WORLD, SA
SEC
12 JC95-01495A 2 JC95-01503A COVER-SCAN RIGHT; CLX-9201, SA
HIPS, T2.5, W165.6, L283.4, G32690,
FG-1790
13 JC95-01495A 2 JC63-03391A COVER-EXIT DUMMY; CLX-9201, PC, SA
0.38, W22,L13.4, G32690
14 JC95-01495A 2 JC63-03402A COVER-RIGHT TOP; CLX-9201, HIPS, SA
T2,W47.5, L223.9, G32690, FG-1790
15 JC95-01495A 2 JC63-03291A COVER-RIGHT INNER MONO; SA
CLX-9201, HIPS, T2,W360.4, L69,
G32690, FG-1790
16 JC95-01495A 2 JC63-03398A COVER-RIGHT HANDLE; SA
SCX-8128NA, WORLD, SEC
17 JC95-01495A 2 JC95-01501A COVER-RIGHT LOWER; CLX-9201, SA
HIPS, T2, W85, L446.3, G32690,
FG-1790
18 JC95-01495A 2 JC63-03292A COVER-RIGHT MONO; CLX-9201, SA
HIPS, T2,W383.5, L198.2, G72797,
HR-1360T
19 JC95-01495A 2 JC61-04568A BRACKET-COVER REAR MONO; SA
SCX-8123NA, PC,0.125, W35,L7,
G72797
20 JC95-01495A 2 JC63-03332A COVER-SCAN REAR; CLX-9201, HIPS, SNA
T2, W365.7, L100, G72797, HR-1360T
21 JC95-01495A 2 JC63-03333A COVER-CONNECTOR DADF; SCX SNA
8133NA, PC,0.125, W35, L7, G72797

Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 25


Exploded Views and Parts List

8. COVER-SIDE MONO
Exploded View

Parts List
No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
1 JC95-01508A 2 JC90-01117A MP-TRAY; W,OD2,L8,PASS,STS304 SA
2 JC95-01508A 2 JC63-03356A COVER-FRONT MP; SNA
CLX-9201,POM,BLACK,70.5,F20-02,U-Type
3 JC95-01508A 2 JC63-03360A COVER-SIDE MONO; SNA
PWH,+,-,B,M3,L6,ZPC(WHT),SWRCH18A,-
4 JC95-01508A 2 JC95-01522A COVER-SIDE DUPLEX; SA
CLX-9201,SUM22,391,6
5 JC95-01508A 2 JC61-04795A GUIDE-DUPLEX UPPER; SNA
ID4,OD9,T0.6,STSC
6 JC95-01508A 2 JC95-01509A COVER-SIDE EXIT; SA
CLX-9201,PC,133.8,BLACK
7 JC95-01508A 2 JC64-00712A HANDLE-SIDE; SCX-8128NA SNA
8 JC95-01508A 2 JC66-03301A SHAFT-HANDLE; SNA
Type5,24,170mA,4.0mmH20,0.433m^3/mi
9 JC95-01508A 2 JC66-03179A ROLLER-DUPLEX; SNA
SUS304,PI0.6,L16.6,ID4.7,OD5.9

26 Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


Exploded Views and Parts List

No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
10 JC95-01508A 2 JC95-01519A COVER-SIDE DUPLEX LOWER; SA
CLX-9201
11 JC95-01508A 2 JC90-01139A MP; SA
CLX-9201,ABS,50.2,335.6,G32690,38,HF-0660I
12 JC95-01508A 2 JC95-01516A COVER-SIDE TAKE AWAY; SA
SCX-8128NA,SEFC340,T0.8,490.1,86.5
13 JC95-01508A 2 6602-003299 BELT-TIMING GEAR; SNA
CLX-9201,EPDM,16,GRAY
14 JC95-01508A 2 JC61-04648A BRACKET-FRONT SIDE MONO; SNA
HWH,+,M3,L6,ZPC(WHT),SWRCH18A,C
TYPE
15 JC95-01508A 2 JC64-00710A LOCKER-SIDE; SCX-8213ND, SNA
UL10272,30p,725mm, BLK, GREY,
BLUE, AWG26,1-353293-5, 3-353294-0,
UL 10272, BOARD TO BOARD WIRE
16 JC95-01508A 2 JC66-03235A LINK-D; CLX-9201 SNA
17 JC95-01508A 2 JC64-00709A LOCKER-GUIDE-FEED; SWP B,0.9, SNA
6.5, 7.4, 28.7
18 JC95-01508A 2 JC63-03361A COVER-HARNESS MONO; CLX-9350, SNA
POM(M90-44), BLACK
19 JC95-01508A 2 JC63-03379A COVER-HARNESS LOWER; SNA
CLX-9201, ABS, 62.1,38.2, HF-0660i,
BLACK, PART
20 JC95-01508A 2 JC95-01518A COVER-SIDE LINK REAR; SA
SCX-8128NA, ABS,94.1,249.6, SPLIT
BROWN BLACK(G32690), HF-0660i
21 JC95-01508A 2 JC95-01510A COVER-SIDE DUPLEX MOTOR; SA
S2M328, RUB(CR), L328
22 JC95-01508A 2 JC66-03292A GEAR-EXIT; ID5.0,OD11.0,T0.6, PASS, SNA
STS304
23 JC95-01508A 2 6107-001731 SPRING-CS; CLX-9201, POM, 19.1,16.1, SA
M90-44, NATURAL
24 JC95-01508A 2 6107-003056 SPRING-ES; SCX-8128NA SNA
25 JC95-01508A 2 JC61-04872A GUIDE-HARNESS; CLX-9350, SNA
Fe+Cu+Zn, ID6, OD9, L6
26 JC95-01508A 2 JC64-00711A LOCKER-SIDE REAR; CLX-9201 SNA
27 JC95-01508A 2 JC61-04649A BRACKET-REAR SIDE MONO; SNA
CLX-9201, SEFC340, T0.8,347. 2,36

Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 27


Exploded Views and Parts List

8.1. MP-TRAY

Exploded View

Parts List
No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
1 JC90-01117A 3 JC61-04759A FRAME-TRAY-LOWER; CLX-9201, SNA
HIPS, 31.5,105, 15.5, FG-1790, G32690,
PAPER
2 JC90-01117A 3 JC61-04758A FRAME-TRAY-UPPER; CLX-9201, SNA
HIPS, 168, 116.7,12, FG-1790, G32690,
PAPER
3 JC90-01117A 3 JC61-04763A GUIDE-TRAY PAPER; CLX-9201, SEC SNA
4 JC90-01117A 3 JC61-04757A BRACKET-TRAY GUIDE; CLX-9201, SNA
POM,1, 170, NATURAL, DE500P, RACK
5 JC90-01117A 3 JC61-04761A GUIDE-SIDE R; CLX-9201, POM, SNA
94.7,7, NATURAL
6 JC90-01117A 3 JC66-03216A GEAR-RACK; PWH,+,-,B,M3, L6, SNA
ZPC(WHT), SWRCH18A,-

28 Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


Exploded Views and Parts List

No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
7 JC90-01117A 3 JC66-03220A LINK-SIDE; COMMON,WHITE PET, SNA
0.05T, 65,26,2 COLOR, TRAY STAMP,
COMMON
8 JC90-01117A 3 JG66-40003A GEAR-PINION; CLX-9201, HIPS, SA
NATURAL BLUE, 342.7, 213.5,
HR-1360T
9 JC90-01117A 3 JC61-04760A GUIDE-SIDE F; CLX-9201, ABS, SNA
G32690, 331, 187, HF-0660I

Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 29


Exploded Views and Parts List

8.2. MP

Exploded View

Parts List
No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
0 JC95-01507A 2 JC90-01139A MP; CLX-9201, SEC SA
1 JC90-01139A 3 JC90-01126A MP GUIDE-MAIN; CLX-9201 SA
2 JC90-01139A 3 JC90-01125A MP-BRACKET PICK UP; CLX-9201, SA
SECC, 0.6T, 67.4,53.1
3 JC90-01139A 3 JC93-00540A FRAME-MAIN PICK UP ROLLER; SA
CLX-9201, ABS, 10, 43.5, 4.5, HF-0660I,
BLACK, GUIDE
4 JC90-01139A 3 JC66-03215A GEAR-IDLE MP; SPY272, DAMPING SNA
GREASE
5 JC90-01139A 3 JC61-00699A BUSH-D6/L4; CLX-9201, SEC SA
6 JC90-01139A 3 JC61-04753A BRACKET-SOLENOID; CLX-9201, SNA
POM,1, 26, 28
7 JC90-01139A 3 JC61-04762A GUIDE-HARNESS R; DACS-2N, SNA
6.2*2.8, Nylon66
8 JC90-01139A 3 JC90-01124A MP-COVER BASE; ID4,OD9, T0.6, SA
STSC
8-1 JC90-01124A 4 JC63-03357A COVER-GUDIE BASE; CLX-9201, SEC SNA

30 Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


Exploded Views and Parts List

No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
8-2 JC90-01124A 4 JC66-03217A LEVER-EMPTY PAPER; SUS304, PI0. SNA
25, ID3.3, OD3.8
8-3 JC90-01124A 4 6107-001771 SPRING-TS; CLX-9201, ABS, 71, 100.5, SA
G32690, HF-0660I

8.2.1. MP-BRACKET PICK UP

Exploded View

Parts List
No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
1 JC90-01125A 4 JC33-00029B SOLENOID-MP; CLX-9201, SEC SA
2 JC90-01125A 4 JC61-04876A GUIDE-UPPER PU MP; CLX-9350, SNA
PORON LE-20, ID10, BLACK, PORON
LE-20
3 JC90-01125A 4 6107-003031 SPRING-ES; CLX-9201, POM, 9.8,34, SNA
M90-44, WHITE
4 JC90-01125A 4 6107-003026 SPRING-ES; CLX-9201, POM, 28.9, SNA
32.3, LZ750, WHITE,LINK
5 JC90-01125A 4 JC66-03218A LEVER-SOLENOID; CLX-9350, Poron, SNA
BLK,1.2,6,4

Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 31


Exploded Views and Parts List

No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
6 JC90-01125A 4 JC90-01127A MP-BRACKET UPPER; CLX-9350, SA
POM, T8.5, OD17, GUIDE
7 JC90-01125A 4 JC66-03222A SHAFT-PICK UP MP; SWP SNA
B,0.65,25.1,4.4,5.7
8 JC90-01125A 4 JC64-00705A LOCKER-STOPPER; SNA
CLX-9201,POM,9,24.2, M90-44,
WHITE, LINK
9 JC90-01125A 4 JC66-00940A GEAR-M_IDLE PU; SWP B,0.5,16.9,4,5 SA
10 JC90-01125A 4 JC66-03303A SHAFT-FORWARD MP; CLX-9350, SNA
DC24V
11 JC90-01125A 4 JC66-03213A GEAR-M PU; SPY272, DAMPING SNA
GREASE
12 JC90-01125A 4 JC61-04766A STOPPER-PAPER; CLX-9201, POM, SNA
BLACK, 29.1,4
13 JC90-01125A 4 JC66-03221A JOINT-PU; ID4, OD9, T0.6, STSC SNA
14 JC90-01125A 4 JC61-03332A ROLLER-IDLE FORWARD; ID3, OD7, SNA
T0.6, PASS, STSC
15 JC90-01125A 4 JC90-00918A MP-ONE WAY; SCX-6320F, BRONZE SA
POWDER(KAB-23)
16 JC90-01125A 4 JC66-03219A LEVER-HOOK; CLX-9201, POM,0.7,21, SNA
16.1
17 JC90-01125A 4 JC66-00977A CLUTCH-P_ONE WAY; CLX-9201, SA
POM, 1,1. 2,14, NATURAL
18 JC90-01125A 4 JC61-01288A HOLDER-M_IDLE ONE WAY; PH,+,M3, SA
L4,NI PLT, SWRCH18A, FP,-

32 Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


Exploded Views and Parts List

8.2.2. MP GUIDE-MAIN

Exploded View

Parts List
No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
1 JC90-01126A 4 JC61-04764A FRAME-BASE MP; CLX-9201, SUM22, SNA
194.6, 6
2 JC90-01126A 4 0604-001393 PHOTO-INTERRUPTER; CLX-9201, SA
SEC
3 JC90-01126A 4 JC63-03359A SHEET-STOPPER; CLX-9201, POM, SNA
6,13,10, BLACK, M90-44
4 JC90-01126A 4 JC69-02047A PAD-MP; SUS304,0.65,17,5.15,6.45 SNA
5 JC90-01126A 4 JC63-03358A SHEET-GUIDE MP; NYLON,CLX-9350, SNA
0.7T, W11.4*L44, Flocking, BLK
6 JC90-01126A 4 JC61-04755A BRACKET-GEAR MP; ID4, OD9, T0.6, SNA
STSC
7 JC90-01126A 4 JC66-03223A SHAFT-RETARD MP; CLX-9201, PET, SNA
0.188, 10, 40

Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 33


Exploded Views and Parts List

No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
8 JC90-01126A 4 JC66-00591A SHAFT-HUB IN; W,D2, L14, PB+Ni SNA
Plating, T0.3
9 JC90-01126A 4 6043-001097 PIN-SPRING; CLP-500, SA
Fe+Cu+Zn-Slearate
10 JC90-01126A 4 JC61-04765A BUSH-RETARD MP; ML-2150, SUM SNA
24L, 8.5, 1.9
11 JC90-01126A 4 6107-003032 SPRING-CS; CLX-9201, PC+GF, SNA
G32690, 98.5, 350.7, NH-3204G
12 JC90-01126A 4 JC67-00455A COUPLER-TORQUELIMITER; SNA
CLX-9201, UL10272, 3p, 250mm,
BLK/GREY, AWG26
13 JC90-01126A 4 JC61-00699A BUSH-D6/L4; CLX-9350, WHITE, SA
350GF*CM
14 JC90-01126A 4 6044-000125 RING-E; TR, 75mW, BGA, TR SA

34 Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


Exploded Views and Parts List

8.3. COVER-SIDE EXIT

Exploded View

Parts List
No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
0 JC95-01507A 2 JC95-01509A COVER-SIDE EXIT; CLX-9201 SA
1 JC95-01509A 3 JC61-04791A GUIDE-SIDE EXIT; ID3, OD7, T0.6, SNA
PASS, STSC
2 JC95-01509A 3 0604-001393 PHOTO-INTERRUPTER; CLX-9201 SA
3 JC95-01509A 3 JC66-03307A ACTUATOR-FUSER OUT; CLX-9201, SNA
MPPO, 340. 9,47.1,25.6, N300X,
BLACK, PART
4 JC95-01509A 3 6107-001737 SPRING-TS; CLX-9201, MPPO, 39. 9, SA
24.1, N300X, BLACK
5 JC95-01509A 3 6107-003055 SPRING-TS; TR, 75mW, BGA, TR SA
6 JC95-01509A 3 6044-000123 RING-E; CLX-9201, UL 10272,3p, SNA
250mm, BLK/GREY
7 JC95-01509A 3 JC61-04792A GUIDE-GATE; SUS304, 0.4, 7.7, 8.1, 180 SNA
8 JC95-01509A 3 JC61-04892A HOLDER-EXIT-SENSOR; SUS304, PI0. SNA
25 ,ID3.8, OD4.3, 105

Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 35


Exploded Views and Parts List

8.4. COVER-SIDE DUPLEX

Exploded View

Parts List
No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
0 JC95-01508A 2 JC95-01522A COVER-SIDE DUPLEX; SCX-8128NA SA
1 JC95-01522A 3 JC61-04879A GUIDE-TR UPPER; SWP B,0.8, 21.1, SNA
4.5, 6.1
2 JC95-01522A 3 JC39-01654A HARNESS-SIDE DUPLEX_TEMP; SNA
SCX-8128NA
3 JC95-01522A 3 JC95-01551A COVER-SIDE TR LOWER; CLX-9350, SA
PC HN-1064i, Black
4 JC95-01522A 3 6107-003021 SPRING-CS; CLX-9350, POM SW-01, SA
NATURAL
5 JC95-01522A 3 JC66-02180A ACTUATOR-DUPLEX 2; CLX-9350, SA
SUM24L, 137.0, 3
6 JC95-01522A 3 0604-001393 PHOTO-INTERRUPTER; SCX-8213ND, SA
UL10272, 5p, 325mm, BLK,GREY
7 JC95-01522A 3 JC61-04808A HOLDER-DUP SNR; SUS304, PI0.25, SNA
ID3.8, OD4.3, 105
8 JC95-01522A 3 6107-001737 SPRING-TS; SCX-8040, SUS,0.2T, 18.2, SA
13.4
9 JC95-01522A 3 JC61-04877A GUIDE-FEED MONO; SCX-8128NA SNA

36 Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


Exploded Views and Parts List

No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
10 JC95-01522A 3 JC66-03277A LINK-TR REAR; SCX-8128NA, ABS, SNA
29.7, 46.3, BLACK, HF-0660i
11 JC95-01522A 3 JC61-04651A PLATE-GROUND_TR_B; SCX-8128NA, SNA
POM, 42.1, T2.0, BLACK
12 JC95-01522A 3 JC61-03581A PLATE-GROUND_SAW_C; SNA
SCX-8128NA, SUS 304, 0.8
13 JC95-01522A 3 JC66-02289B ROLLER-IDLE; SCX-8128NA, SNA
ABS+PC, 390.2, 135.3, NH-1000T,
BLACK, GUIDE
14 JC95-01522A 3 JC66-02354A SHAFT-ROLLER IDLE L; SCX-8128NA, SNA
ABS+PC, 320.5, 36.5, NH-1000T,
BLACK, GUIDE
15 JC95-01522A 3 6107-001731 SPRING-CS; SCX-8128NA, SA
STAINLESS-STS304, T0.2, 21.3,
11.9, GROUND

Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 37


Exploded Views and Parts List

9. DADF
Exploded View

Parts List
No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
1 JC97-03989A 2 JC97-03997A DADF PLATEN; CLX-9201, SEC SA
2 JC97-03989A 2 JC97-03991A DADF-SUB; CLX-9201, SEC SA
3 JC97-03989A 2 JC97-03995A DADF-HINGE L; BH,+,B, M4,L16, NI SA
PLT, SWRCH18A
4 JC97-03989A 2 JC97-03996A DADF-HINGE R; BH,+,B,M4, L10,NI SA
PLT, SWRCH18A
5 JC97-03989A 2 JC63-03345A COVER-SIDE_F; CLP-500, ART PAPER, SNA
W62, L13, WHITE, COMMON
6 JC97-03989A 2 JC63-03354A COVER-DECO_R; CLX-9201, SEC SNA
7 JC97-03989A 2 JC63-03346A COVER-SIDE_R; CLX-9201, HIPS, SNA
2, 480, 75, Naoto Brown Black,166,
HR-1360T
8 JC97-03989A 2 JC63-03353A COVER-DECO_F; CLX-9201, SEC SNA

38 Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


Exploded Views and Parts List

9.1. DADF-SUB

Exploded View

Parts List
No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
1 JC97-03991A 3 JC97-03990A DADF OPEN-COVER; CLX-9201, SEC SA
2 JC97-03991A 3 JC97-03992A DADF FRAME-MAIN; CLX-9201, SEC SA
3 JC97-03991A 3 JC97-03993A DADF-MOTOR; CLX-9201, SEC SA
4 JC97-03991A 3 JC97-03994A DADF STACKER; PWH,+, B,M3, SA
L10,NI PLT, SWRCH18A

Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 39


Exploded Views and Parts List

9.1.1. DADF OPEN-COVER

Exploded View

Parts List
No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
0 JC97-03991A 3 JC97-03990A DADF OPEN-COVER; CLX-9201, SEC SA
1 JC97-03990A 4 JC63-03273A COVER-OPEN; CLX-9201, HIPS, 322, SNA
Naoto Brown Black
2 JC97-03990A 4 JC64-00682A HANDLE-COVER_OPEN; CLX-9201, SNA
POM, 33.7, WHITE
3 JC97-03990A 4 6107-003033 SPRING-ES; CLX-6240FX, PORON, 1. SA
0,7. 8,4, BLACK
4 JC97-03990A 4 6107-003022 SPRING-CS; CLX-9201, SEC SA
5 JC97-03990A 4 6107-001737 SPRING-TS; CLX-9201, SEC SA
6 JC97-03990A 4 JC61-00482A SPRING ETC-PICKUP; CLX-9201, SA
POM, BLACK
7 JC97-03990A 4 JC97-04009A DADF GUIDE-PIKCUP; CLX-9350, SA
POM, 18
8 JC97-03990A 4 JC66-03148A ACTUATOR-REGI; CLX-9201, SUM22, SNA
169,4

40 Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


Exploded Views and Parts List

No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
9 JC97-03990A 4 JC66-03147A ACTUATOR-DETECT; SWP, 1.2,22, SNA
10.2, 11.4,9, FREE
10 JC97-03990A 4 JC66-02384A ROLLER-IDLE TAKE AWAY; SNA
CLX-9201, HIPS, 2, 303.7, Naoto Brown
Black, 35.7
11 JC97-03990A 4 JC63-03274A COVER-OPEN_INNER; SUS304, PI0. SNA
25 ,ID3.8, OD4.3, 105
12 JC97-03990A 4 JC61-04647A STOPPER-PAPER; CLX-9201, PC, 159.5 SNA

9.1.2. DADF FRAME-MAIN

Exploded View

Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 41


Exploded Views and Parts List

Parts List
No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
0 JC97-03991A 3 JC97-03992A DADF FRAME-MAIN; CLX-9201, SEC SA
1 JC97-03992A 4 JC97-03097A MEA-HOLDER ADF RUBBER; SA
CLX-9201, EPDM, 16, GRAY
2 JC97-03992A 4 JC69-02810A PAD-GUIDE_PICKUP; SCX-1110F, SNA
STS303, L10.0, D2.0
3 JC97-03992A 4 JC61-04583A GUIDE-PICK_UP; M4,ID4.3, OD9, T0.8, SNA
ZPC(YEL), SCP
4 JC97-03992A 4 JC61-04908A BRACKET-EXIT; SCX-5312F, SNA
SUS304WPB, PI0.65, 6.4mm, 7.7mm
5 JC97-03992A 4 JC67-00562A BRUSH-ANTISTATIC; SUS304, 0.26, SNA
4.05, 2.4,4.3,9.2, RIGHT HAND, 6.6, 6.6,
115
6 JC97-03992A 4 JC66-03095A ROLLER-EXIT; TR, 75mW, BGA, TR SNA
7 JC97-03992A 4 JC66-03094A ROLLER-REGI; POLYMIDE, ID8.1, SNA
OD12, T0.2,BLK
8 JC97-03992A 4 0604-001393 PHOTO-INTERRUPTER; CLX-9201, SA
POM, 12.0, BLACK
9 JC97-03992A 4 JC47-00033A CLUTCH-ELECTRIC; CLX-9201, PU, SA
1.0, 10,35
10 JC97-03992A 4 JC66-03261A GEAR-EXIT; ML-3200ND, DC24V, SA
125mA, Z24, M1, 2.5KGF, SLIM TYPE
11 JC97-03992A 4 JC66-02296A ROLLER-TENSION IDLE; CLX-9201, SNA
UL10272, 3P, 200mm, GRAY/BLK,
AWG26
12 JC97-03992A 4 6602-003186 BELT-TIMING GEAR; CLX-9201, SUS, SNA
0.2,143. 29, GROUND
13 JC97-03992A 4 6602-003183 BELT-TIMING GEAR; CLX-9201, PC, SNA
126.2
14 JC97-03992A 4 JC66-03267A GEAR-REDUCTION_KNOB; SA
POLYSLIDER,ID4, OD7, T0.5,
Black, side-Cutting
15 JC97-03992A 4 JC66-03264A GEAR-IDLE_CLUTCH; CLX-9201, SA
ABS, 2,344
16 JC97-03992A 4 JC66-03184A ACTUATOR-EXIT; CLX-9201, POM, SNA
0.8,20, BLACK, 17.6, JGMA3
17 JC97-03992A 4 JC66-03177A ROLLER-EXIT_IDLE; CLX-9201, POM, SNA
37.5, BLACK
18 JC97-03992A 4 JC61-04833A HOLDER-EXIT IDLE_R; CLX-9201, SNA
PET, 0.125, 10,35
19 JC97-03992A 4 JC66-03093A ROLLER-FEED; CLX-9201, SNA
POM,6,19.864
20 JC97-03992A 4 JC61-00548A SPRING ETC-WHITE BAR; PWH,+,B, SA
M3, L10,NI PLT, SWRCH18A
21 JC97-03992A 4 JC61-04584A GUIDE-WHITE_BAR; 40S2M258, SNA
RUBBER, W4.0, L258, BLACK

42 Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


Exploded Views and Parts List

9.1.3. DADF-MOTOR

Exploded View

Parts List
No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
0 JC97-03991A 3 JC97-03993A DADF-MOTOR; CLX-9201, SEC SA
1 JC97-03993A 4 JC31-00156A MOTOR BLDC-TYPE1; CLX-9201, SA
POM, 0.5/1. 0,55/25, BLACK, 30.265/27,
JGMA3
2 JC97-03993A 4 JC33-00007A SOLENOID-PICK UP; TR,75mW, BGA, SA
TR
3 JC97-03993A 4 JC61-04534A HOLDER-HARNESS; ML-3200ND, SNA
DC24V, 125mA, Z24,M1,2.5KGF,SLIM
TYPE
4 JC97-03993A 4 JC61-00699B BUSH-EXIT; CLX-9201,EGI-SECC, SA
1.0,60, 200, NATURAL
5 JC97-03993A 4 JC61-04627A BRACKET-MOTOR; SWP, 0.16, SNA
19,2.4,2.7,14, FREE
6 JC97-03993A 4 0604-001393 PHOTO-INTERRUPTER; CLX-9201, SA
HIPS, 197.5, BLACK
7 JC97-03993A 4 JC47-00033A CLUTCH-ELECTRIC; CLX-9201, POM, SA
1.0,20, BLACK, 22, JGMA3

Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 43


Exploded Views and Parts List

No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
8 JC97-03993A 4 JC66-03260A GEAR-CAM_OUTER; HWH,+, M3,L6, SA
ZPC(WHT), SWRCH18A, C TYPE
9 JC97-03993A 4 JC66-03265A GEAR-PICKUP_IDLE; CLX-9201, SA
POM,1.0,16, BLACK,18.4, JGMA3
10 JC97-03993A 4 JC66-03263A GEAR-REDUCTION; CLX-9201, POM, SA
1.0,28, BLACK,30.0, JGAM3
11 JC97-03993A 4 JC66-03259A GEAR-CAM_INNER; CLX-9350, SA
Fe+Cu+Zn-Slearate
12 JC97-03993A 4 JC66-03262A GEAR-EXIT_IDLE; CLX-9201, SEC SA
13 JC97-03993A 4 6107-003036 SPRING-ES; SPY272, DAMPING SA
GREASE

9.1.4. DADF STACKER

Exploded View

44 Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


Exploded Views and Parts List

Parts List
No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
0 JC97-03991A 3 JC97-03994A DADF STACKER; CLX-9201, SEC SA
1 JC97-03994A 4 JC61-04748A GUIDE-DOC_F; CLX-9201, ABS, 33.08, SNA
158.53, HF-0660I, GUIDE
2 JC97-03994A 4 JC61-04746A GUIDE-STACKER_UPPER; CF4500, SNA
POM, NTR+WHT(DELRIN500), HB
3 JC97-03994A 4 JC61-04749A GUIDE-DOC_R; CLX-9201, ABS, 37, SNA
224.09, HF-0660i, GUIDE
4 JC97-03994A 4 JC66-03209A ACTUATOR-PAPER_LENGTH; SNA
CLX-9350, PC, 0.254, 29,22
5 JC97-03994A 4 0604-001393 PHOTO-INTERRUPTER; CLX-9201, SA
SEC
6 JC97-03994A 4 JC61-04751A GUIDE-GEAR_RACK_R; CLX-9201, SNA
PC, 0.254, 47.7, 146.51
7 JC97-03994A 4 JC61-04750A GUIDE-GEAR_RACK_F; SNA
SCX-6345N/XRX, SUS, PI1.5,81.0,121.5,
NTR, PAPER
8 JC97-03994A 4 JF72-41354A PMO-GEAR PINION; CLX-9201, SNA
HIPS,2, 125,50, 17.4, HR-1360T, Naoto
Brown Black, GUIDE
9 JC97-03994A 4 JC61-04747A GUIDE-STACKER_LOWER; CLX-9201, SNA
PC, 80, 40, Naoto Brown Black
10 JC97-03994A 4 JC61-01438A GUIDE-STACKER WIRE; BH,+,-,B,M3, SNA
L8, ZPC(BLK), SWRCH18A,-

Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 45


Exploded Views and Parts List

9.2. DADF PLATEN_Mono

Exploded View

Parts List
No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
1 JC97-03997A 3 JC63-03348A COVER-PLATEN; SCX-6345N/XRX, SNA
POM, OD14, L23,WHT
2 JC97-03997A 3 0604-001393 PHOTO-INTERRUPTER; CLX-9201, SA
SEC
3 JC97-03997A 3 JC63-03347A COVER-DUMMY_PLATEN; TR,75mW, SNA
BGA, TR
4 JC97-03997A 3 JC66-03211A SHAFT-IDLE_FEED; SUS304, 0.26, SNA
4.05, 2.4,4.3,9.2, RIGHT HAND, 6.6,6.6,
115
5 JC97-03997A 3 JC66-01022A ROLLER-M_IDLE SCF; CLX-9201, PC, SA
145, 40, BLACK, ACTUATOR-High Tem
6 JC97-03997A 3 JC66-03210A ACTUATOR-SCAN; CLX-9201, SNA
SUS,0.2,59, GROUND
7 JC97-03997A 3 6107-002241 SPRING-ES; CLX-9201, SUM22, 172,4 SA

46 Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


Exploded Views and Parts List

No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
8 JC97-03997A 3 JC63-03351A GROUND-HINGE_RIGHT; SUS,PI0.5, SNA
L19.7, OD5.6
9 JC97-03997A 3 JC63-03349A GROUND-HINGE_FRAME; CLX-9201, SNA
SUS, 0.2, 80, GROUND
10 JC97-03997A 3 JC61-40001A FOOT-ML80; CLX-9201, HIPS,2,550, SNA
480, Naoto Brown Black, 1080, HR-1360T

Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 47


Exploded Views and Parts List

10.OPE_Mono
Exploded View

Parts List
No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
0 SCX-8128NA/SEE 1 JC97-04006B OPE; CLX-9201, WORLD, SEC SNA
1 JC97-04006A 2 JC63-03409A COVER-FRONT DUMMY OPE; SA
CLX-9201, WORLD, SEC
2 JC97-04006A 2 JC97-04007A OPE-FRONT; CLX-9201, SECC,T0.8, SA
W220, L150
2-1 JC97-04007A 3 JC63-03407A COVER-FRONT OPE; CLX-9201, HIPS, SA
19*14, T2, C82824
2-2 JC97-04007A 3 JC07-00021A LCD; CLX-9201, PMMA, 52*18, T2.0 SA
2-3 JC97-04007A 3 JC64-00683A KEY-JOB STATUS; CLX-9201, HIPS, SA
21*22, T2, C82824
2-4 JC97-04007A 3 JC67-00586A LENS-ECO; DOUBLE TAPE,6, 100 SNA
2-5 JC97-04007A 3 JC64-00691A KEY-POWER; CLX-9201, WORLD, SEC SA
2-6 JC97-04007A 3 JC64-00685A KEY-STOP; PWH,+,B,M3, L10, NI SA
PLT,SWRCH18A

48 Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


Exploded Views and Parts List

No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
2-7 JC97-04007A 3 JC64-00686A KEY-START; CLX-9201, HIPS, 58*15, SA
T2, C82824
2-8 JC97-04007A 3 JC64-00684A KEY-M TEL; CLX-9201, PMMA, Milky, SA
18.6*14.1, T 2.0
2-9 JC97-04007A 3 JC61-04561A BRACKET-LCD; CLX-9201, SUS, 0.3, SA
W190, L120, GROUND
2-10 JC97-04007A 3 JC63-03310A GROUND-TOUCH; CLX-9201, HIPS, SA
T2.5, W327, L118, C82824
2-11 JC97-04007A 3 JC39-01575A FLAT CABLE-KEY; SNA
CLX-9201/9251/9301, SEC, FR-4,
6LAYER
2-12 JC97-04007A 3 JC67-00560A LENS-STATUS; CLX-9201, 20P, 0.065, SA
135mm, AWM20624, 1.0mm, WHITE
2-13 JC97-04007A 3 JC92-02436A PBA-OPE; HWH,+, M3, L8, ZPC(WHT), SA
SWRCH18A, C TYPE
2-14 JC97-04006B 2 JC92-02435A PBA-OPE KEY; CLX-9201/9251/9301, SA
SEC, FR-1, 1LAYER
3 JC97-04006A 2 JC63-03408A COVER-BOTTOM OPE; CLX-9201, SA
WORLD, SEC
4 JC97-04006A 2 JC61-04567A BRACKET-SUPPORT; PET, 0.125, 190, SA
110

Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 49


Exploded Views and Parts List

11.PLATEN FR HR
Exploded View

Parts List
No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
1 JC97-04005A 3 JC97-04002A PLATEN FR HR-UPPER; CLX-9201, SNA
SCANNER
2 JC97-04005A 3 JC97-03985A PLATEN FR HR-LOWER; CLX-9201, SA
SCANNER
3 JC97-04020A 2 0604-001453 PHOTO-INTERRUPTER; CLX-9201, SA
ABS, 60, 60, BLACK
4 JC97-04020A 2 JC61-04569A HOLDER-APS; #8915, T0.15, W12, SNA
L55M, CLR,-
5 JC97-04020A 2 JC61-04638A PLATE-ALIGN COVER; 346*30, 3.2 SNA
6 JC97-04020A 2 JC63-03296A COVER-GLASS; 1401C, SNA
RED,-,BOND-LOCK SCREW

50 Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


Exploded Views and Parts List

No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
7 JC97-04020A 2 JC01-00072A GLASS-SCAN; PORON,1.0, 331, 2.5, SA
BLACK
8 JC97-04020A 2 JC61-04814A GUIDE-PAPER V; 459.4*346, 3.2 SNA
9 JC97-04020A 2 JC01-00073A GLASS-SCAN ADF; HWH,+, M3, L6, SA
ZPC(WHT), SWRCH18A, C TYPE
10 JC97-04020A 2 JC61-04811A GUIDE-ADF-PATH; CLX-9201, PC, SNA
1,9.5, 339, PART
11 JC97-04020A 2 JC61-04815A GUIDE-PAPER H; CLX-9201, SNA
SCANNER
12 JC97-04020A 2 JC63-03315A SPONGE-GUIDE ADF; CLX-9201, PC, SNA
1,30, 435, PART

Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 51


Exploded Views and Parts List

11.1. PLATEN FR HR-LOWER

Exploded View

Parts List
No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
1 JC97-03985A 4 JC97-03983A PLATEN FR HR-CARRIAGE FR; ID5.0, SA
OD11.0, T0.6, PASS, STS304
2 JC97-03985A 4 JC97-03984A PLATEN FR HR-CARRIAGE HR; SA
CLX-9201, SCANNER
3 JC97-03985A 4 JC61-04674A FRAME-BASE; CLX-9201, SCANNER SNA
4 JC97-03985A 4 6107-001698 SPRING-ES; CLX-9201, ABS, 92,52, SA
BLACK
5 JC97-03985A 4 JC97-03998A PLATEN FR HR-STRING FRONT; SUS, SNA
PI0.8, L42, OD6.4
6 JC97-03985A 4 JC97-03999A PLATEN FR HR-STRING REAR; SNA
17PM-K049-P6WS, 1.2A, 5.2W, 2.2V
7 JC97-03985A 4 JC97-03986A PLATEN FR HR-RAIL LOWER F; SA
CLX-9201, SECC, 1,409, 532
8 JC97-03985A 4 JC97-03987A PLATEN FR HR-RAIL LOWER R; SA
CLX-9201, UL10272,6

52 Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.


Exploded Views and Parts List

No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
9 JC97-03985A 4 JC97-03988A PLATEN FR HR-RAIL UPPER; SA
CLX-9201, SCANNER
10 JC97-03985A 4 JC61-04572A HOLDER-CABLE; ML-9400W, bearing SNA
11 JC97-03985A 4 0604-001393 PHOTO-INTERRUPTER; CLX-9201, SA
SCANNER
12 JC97-03985A 4 6044-000130 RING-E; CLX-9201, SECC, 1.0, 102,41 SNA
13 JC97-03985A 4 6044-000231 RING-E; CLX-9201,SECC, 1.6, 80, 56 SNA
14 JC97-03985A 4 JC66-03242A PULLEY-DRIVING; ID7, OD14, T0.8, SNA
PASS, STSC
15 JC97-03985A 4 JC64-00508A HANDLE-SOCKET SET SCREW; SNA
CLX-9201, SUM22, 438, 8
16 JC97-03985A 4 JC66-03186A SHAFT-DRIVING; SF4000, CR SNA
RUBBER, W14XL14, BLK,3
17 JC97-03985A 4 JC66-02257A PULLEY-BELT; CLX-9201, SCANNER SA
18 JC97-03985A 4 JC39-01673A FLAT CABLE-CCD IF; CLX-9201, SNA
SCANNER
19 JC97-03985A 4 JG61-40001A FOOT-SF4000; DAGM-15,10. 5X5.0, SA
Nylon66
20 JC97-03985A 4 6602-001725 BELT-TIMING GEAR; CLX-9201, PC, SA
BLACK,8,33
21 JC97-03985A 4 JC61-04629A BRACKET-SUPPORT; CLX-9350, SNA
SWCH18A, 4,6
22 JC97-03985A 4 JC31-00158A MOTOR STEP; CLX-9201, SCANNER SA
23 JC97-03985A 4 JC61-04630A BRACKET-MOTOR; CLX-9201, 40P, SNA
600mm, AWM20624, 1.0mm
24 JC97-03985A 4 6502-001152 CABLE CLAMP; HWH,+,M3, SNA
L6,ZPC(WHT), SWRCH18A, C TYPE

Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved. 53


Exploded Views and Parts List

11.2. PLATEN FR HR-UPPER

Exploded View

Parts List
No. Parent Lvl. Loc. Material Code Description & Specification SNA Qty.
1 JC97-04002A 4 JC61-04693A FRAME-COVER; PC, 0.125, 24,9, SNA
TRANSPARENT
2 JC97-04002A 4 JC63-03314A GROUND-HINGE; CLX-9201, ABS, 59, SNA
61, G61881
3 JC97-04002A 4 JC61-04574A HOLDER-HINGE-R; DACS-2N, 6.2*2.8, SNA
Nylon66
4 JC97-04002A 4 JC61-04573A HOLDER-HINGE-L; CLX-9201 SNA
5 JC97-04002A 4 JC92-02447A PBA-SCAN JOINT; CLX-9201, SNA
SCANNER
6 JC97-04002A 4 JC97-04003A PLATEN FR HR-OPEN SENSOR; SNA
CLX-9201, SUS, 0.2, 70, 50, GROUND

54 Copyright 1995-2011 SAMSUNG. All rights reserved.

You might also like